blob: 6db0b7df4b3c4caa87a250126fdd94c29f097f7c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
William Lallemand1a82cdf2024-02-26 19:04:22 +01006 2024/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +0000593.11. HTTPClient tuning
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020060
614. Proxies
624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
64
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200665.1. Bind options
675.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200685.3. Server DNS resolution
695.3.1. Global overview
705.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100726. Cache
736.1. Limitation
746.2. Setup
756.2.1. Cache section
766.2.2. Proxy section
77
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
797.1. ACL basics
807.1.1. Matching booleans
817.1.2. Matching integers
827.1.3. Matching strings
837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
847.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
867.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
877.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200887.3.1. Converters
897.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
907.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096
978. Logging
988.1. Log levels
998.2. Log formats
1008.2.1. Default log format
1018.2.2. TCP log format
1028.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001038.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001048.2.5. Error log format
1058.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001068.3. Advanced logging options
1078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1088.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1098.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1118.4. Timing events
1128.5. Session state at disconnection
1138.6. Non-printable characters
1148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1168.9. Examples of logs
117
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001189. Supported filters
1199.1. Trace
1209.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001229.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001239.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001249.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001259.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200126
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012710. FastCGI applications
12810.1. Setup
12910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
13010.1.2. Proxy section
13110.1.3. Example
13210.2. Default parameters
13310.3. Limitations
134
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013511. Address formats
13611.1. Address family prefixes
13711.2. Socket type prefixes
13811.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
1401. Quick reminder about HTTP
141----------------------------
142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
145on almost anything found in the contents.
146
147However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
148formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
149correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
150
151
1521.1. The HTTP transaction model
153-------------------------------
154
155The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100156to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100157from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
158connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159will involve a new connection :
160
161 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
162
163In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
164establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
165by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
166length.
167
168Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
169to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
170however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
171response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
172header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
173
174 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
175
176Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
177power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
178but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200179a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
183second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
184page :
185
186 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
187
188This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
189latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
190correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
191the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100192server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200194The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
195This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
196streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100197parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
198carry the stream identifier.
199
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200200
201HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200202head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200203streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
204other streams.
205
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
207connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
208leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100209start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
210processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
211waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200212
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200213HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100214 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
215 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100216 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200218 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100219
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221
2221.2. HTTP request
223-----------------
224
225First, let's consider this HTTP request :
226
227 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100228 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
230 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
231 3 User-agent: my small browser
232 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
233 5 Accept: image/png
234
235
2361.2.1. The Request line
237-----------------------
238
239Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
240
241 - a METHOD : GET
242 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
244
245All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
246which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
247followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
248is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
249desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
250the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
251
252The URI itself can have several forms :
253
254 - A "relative URI" :
255
256 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
257
258 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
259 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
260
261 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
262
263 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
264
265 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
266 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
267 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
268 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
269 must accept this form too.
270
271 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
272 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
273 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
276 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
277 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
278 other protocols too.
279
280In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
281mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
282on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
283It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
284specific to the language, framework or application in use.
285
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.2.2. The request headers
291--------------------------
292
293The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
294beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
295an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
296Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
297values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
298encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
299the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
300define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100302Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100304"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200305as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
306normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
307representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
308HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309
310The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
311that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
312is one valid form of empty line.
313
314Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
315headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
316about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
317application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
318
319Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000320 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
322 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
323 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
324
325
3261.3. HTTP response
327------------------
328
329An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
330messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
331
332 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100333 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
335 2 Content-length: 350
336 3 Content-Type: text/html
337
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200338As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
339codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
340response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
342the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
343following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
344sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
345(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
346correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
347such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
348state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400349over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100350if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
351information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003541.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355------------------------
356
357Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
358
359 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
360 - a status code : 200
361 - a reason : OK
362
363The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100364 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
365 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
366 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
367 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
368 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000370Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100371"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
373messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
374or "Authentication Required".
375
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100376HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
378 Code When / reason
379 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
380 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
381 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100383 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
384 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 400 for an invalid or too large request
386 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
387 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100389 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100391 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
392 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200394 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400395 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100396 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200398 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200399 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
400 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
401 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
402
403The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4044.2).
405
406
4071.3.2. The response headers
408---------------------------
409
410Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
411the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
412details.
413
414
4152. Configuring HAProxy
416----------------------
417
4182.1. Configuration file format
419------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200420
421HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
422
423 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700425 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200427
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100428The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
429a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100430
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100431 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
432
433 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
434
435 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
436 tab characters
437
438 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
439 keyword sequences listed in this document
440
441 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
442 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
443 parts of the configuration, or expressions
444
445 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
446 are supported
447
448 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
449 section
450
451This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
452generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
453figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
454
455First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
456the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
457a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
458word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
459follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
460the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
461the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
462the parts that need to be addressed.
463
464A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
465requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
466extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
467the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
468section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
469section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
470not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
471
472A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
473each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
474a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
475start a new one.
476
477Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
478that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
479applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
480"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
481processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
482ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
483which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
484In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
485of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
486identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
487such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4882, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
489
490 listen foo
491 bind :80
492
493 listen bar
494 bind :81
495
496Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
497spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
498of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
499following configurations are strictly equivalent:
500
501 global#this is the global section
502 daemon#daemonize
503 frontend foo
504 mode http # or tcp
505
506and:
507
508 global
509 daemon
510
511 # this is the public web frontend
512 frontend foo
513 mode http
514
515The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
516new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
517other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
518section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
519section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
520at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
521
522Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
523are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
524editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
525support automatic indent.
526
527In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
528positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
529modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
530anymore, and is not recommended.
531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200532
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005332.2. Quoting and escaping
534-------------------------
535
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100536In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
537that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
538possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
539in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
540('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
543very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
544the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
545also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
546delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
547word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
548remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200549
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100550If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
551(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
552
553Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
554backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200555
556 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
557 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
558 \\ to use a backslash
559 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
560 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
561
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100562In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
563C-language representation:
564
565 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
566 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
567 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
568 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
569
570Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
571or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
572of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
576 # hash as a comment start
577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
579evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
580dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
581backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
584character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
585is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200586
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100587As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
588entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
589name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
590represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300591hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200592
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100593 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
594 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
595 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300596 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
597 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
598 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
599 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
600 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100601 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300602 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300604 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300606 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100607 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300608 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
609 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
610 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300612 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200613
614 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100615 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200616 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
617 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
618 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
619 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
620 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
621
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100622There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
623necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
624by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
625they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
626escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
627characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
628case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
629if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
630own quotes.
631
632The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600633quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500634not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100635quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
636
637Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
638arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
639
640 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
642
643Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
644"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
645cannot write:
646
647 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
648
649because we would like the string to cut like this:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
652 |---------|----|-|
653 arg1 _/ / /
654 arg2 __________/ /
655 arg3 ______________/
656
657but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
658parenthesis then garbage:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
661 |--------|--------|
662 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
663 trailing garbage _________/
664
665The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
666quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
667processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
668this word:
669
670 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
672 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
673
674So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
675still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
676the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
677the second level:
678
679 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
680 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2=blah ___________/ /
685 arg3=g _______________/
686
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500687Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100688double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
689
690 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
691 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
692 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
693 |---------||----|-|
694 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
695 arg2 ___________/ /
696 arg3 _______________/
697
698When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
699appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
700string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
701thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
702
703 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
704 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
705 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
706 |-------------| |-----||-|
707 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
708 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
709 arg3 ______________________/
710
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400711Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600712that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100713quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
714single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
715level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
716
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600717Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
718if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
719or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
720
721 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
723 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
724
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100725When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
726double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600727and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100728a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
729a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
730the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
731regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
732around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
733more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200734
735
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007362.3. Environment variables
737--------------------------
738
739HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
740interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
741configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
742optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
743shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200744underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
745list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
746arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100747before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
748use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
749next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
750existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200751
752 Example:
753
754 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
755
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100756 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200757
758 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
759
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200760Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
761file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200762
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200763* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
764 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
765
766* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
767 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
768 directory.
769
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100770* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
771 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
772 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
773
774 Example:
775 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
776 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
777
778* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
779 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
780
781* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
782 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
785
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500786* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200787 processes, separated by semicolons.
788
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500789* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200790 CLI, separated by semicolons.
791
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100792* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
793 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
794 updating the binary and reloading.
795
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500796* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
797 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
798 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
799 branch number.
800
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200801In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
802regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
803only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
804
805* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
806
807* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
808 starting at one.
809
810* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
811 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
812 first section.
813
814These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
815if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
816section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
817"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
818proxies.
819
820This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
821logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
822to name some config objects like servers for example.
823
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200824See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200825
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100826
8272.4. Conditional blocks
828-----------------------
829
830It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
831some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
832ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
833configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
834versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
835preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
836text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
837lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
838switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
839are defined to form conditional blocks:
840
841 - .if <condition>
842 - .elif <condition>
843 - .else
844 - .endif
845
846The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
847as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
848matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
849there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
850only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
851".elif" of a block.
852
853Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
854ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
855as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
856
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200857Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
858See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
859
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200860The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
861expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100862
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100863 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
864 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200865 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530867 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
868 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200869 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
870 from left to right until one returns false
871 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
872 from right to left until one returns true
873
874Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
875operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200876
877The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
878
879 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
880 exists, regardless of its contents
881
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200882 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
883 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
884 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
885
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200886 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
887 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100888 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200889
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200890 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
891 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
892 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
893 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
894
895 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
896 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
897 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
898 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
899
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100900 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
901 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100902 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
903 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
904 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100905
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200906Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100907
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200908 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
909 listen mwcli_px
910 bind :1111
911 ...
912 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200914 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
915 bind :80
916 .endif
917
918 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200919 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200920 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200921 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200922 .endif
923
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200924 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200925 bind :443 ssl crt ...
926 .endif
927
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200928 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
929 profiling.memory on
930 .endif
931
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200932 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
933 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
934 .endif
935
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200936Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100937
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200938 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100939 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
940 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
941 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
942
943Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
944"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
945fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
946provide advice to the user.
947
948Example:
949
950 .if "${A}"
951 .if "${B}"
952 .notice "A=1, B=1"
953 .elif "${C}"
954 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
955 .elif "${D}"
956 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
957 .else
958 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
959 .endif
960 .else
961 .notice "A=0"
962 .endif
963
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200964 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
965 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
966
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100967
9682.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200969----------------
970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100971Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100972values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
973otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
974numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
975for every keyword. Supported units are :
976
977 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
978 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
979 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
980 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
981 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
982 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
983
984
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009852.6. Size format
986----------------
987
988Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
989These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
990otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
991numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
992for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
993
994 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
995 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
996 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
997
998Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
999
1000
10012.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002-------------
1003
1004 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1005 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1006 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1007 global
1008 daemon
1009 maxconn 256
1010
1011 defaults
1012 mode http
1013 timeout connect 5000ms
1014 timeout client 50000ms
1015 timeout server 50000ms
1016
1017 frontend http-in
1018 bind *:80
1019 default_backend servers
1020
1021 backend servers
1022 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1023
1024
1025 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1026 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1027 global
1028 daemon
1029 maxconn 256
1030
1031 defaults
1032 mode http
1033 timeout connect 5000ms
1034 timeout client 50000ms
1035 timeout server 50000ms
1036
1037 listen http-in
1038 bind *:80
1039 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1040
1041
1042Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1043
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001044 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001045
1046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010473. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048--------------------
1049
1050Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1051are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1052of them have command-line equivalents.
1053
1054The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1055
1056 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001057 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - 51degrees-cache-size
1059 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001060 - 51degrees-difference
1061 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001062 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1063 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001064 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1065 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001066 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001068 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001069 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001070 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001071 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001072 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001073 - description
1074 - deviceatlas-json-file
1075 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001076 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001077 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001078 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001079 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001080 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001081 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001082 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1085 - h1-case-adjust
1086 - h1-case-adjust-file
1087 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001088 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001089 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001090 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001091 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001092 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001094 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001095 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001096 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001097 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001098 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001099 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001100 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001101 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001102 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001104 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001105 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001106 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001107 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001108 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001109 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001110 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001111 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001112 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001113 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001114 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001115 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001116 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001117 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001118 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001119 - ssl-default-server-options
1120 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001121 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001122 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001123 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001124 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001125 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001126 - stats
1127 - strict-limits
1128 - uid
1129 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001130 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001131 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001132 - user
1133 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001134 - wurfl-data-file
1135 - wurfl-information-list
1136 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001139 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001140 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001141 - maxcompcpuusage
1142 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001143 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001144 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001145 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001146 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001147 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001148 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001149 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001150 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001152 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001153 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001154 - nokqueue
1155 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001156 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001157 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001158 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001159 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001160 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001161 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001162 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001163 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001164 - tune.buffers.limit
1165 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001166 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001167 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001168 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001169 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001170 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001171 - tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001172 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1173 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01001174 - tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001175 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1176 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001177 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001178 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001179 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001180 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001181 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001182 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001183 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001184 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001185 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001186 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001187 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001188 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001189 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001190 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1191 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001192 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1193 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001194 - tune.maxaccept
1195 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001196 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001197 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001198 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001199 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001200 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001201 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1202 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001203 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001204 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001205 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001206 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frederic Lecaillefd9424d2024-02-16 15:28:30 +01001207 - tune.quic.reorder-ratio
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001208 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001209 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001210 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1211 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001212 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001213 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001214 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001215 - tune.sndbuf.client
1216 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001217 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001218 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001219 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1220 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1221 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001222 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1223 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001224 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001225 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1226 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001227 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001228 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1229 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001230 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001231 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001232 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1233 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1234 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001235 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1236 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001237
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001238 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001239 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001240 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001241 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +00001243 * HTTPClient
1244 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
1245 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1246 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1247 - httpclient.retries
1248 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1249 - httpclient.ssl.verify
1250 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012523.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001253------------------------------------
1254
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125551degrees-data-file <file path>
1256 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1257 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1258
1259 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001260 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001261
126251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1263 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1264 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1265 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1266
1267 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001269
127051degrees-property-separator <char>
1271 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1272 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1273
1274 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001275 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001276
127751degrees-cache-size <number>
1278 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1279 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1280 By default, this cache is disabled.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001283 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001284
128551degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1286 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1287 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1288
1289 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001290 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001291
129251degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1293 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1294 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001297 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001298
129951degrees-drift <number>
1300 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1301
1302 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001303 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001304
130551degrees-difference <number>
1306 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1307
1308 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001309 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001310
131151degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1312 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1313 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1314
1315 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001316 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001317
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001318ca-base <dir>
1319 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001320 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1321 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1322 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324chroot <jail dir>
1325 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1326 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1327 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1328 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1329 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001330 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001331
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001332close-spread-time <time>
1333 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1334 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1335 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1336 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1337 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1338 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1339 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1340 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001341 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1342 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1343 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1344 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1345 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001346
1347 Arguments :
1348 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001349 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1350 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001351
1352 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1353 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1354 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1355
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001356 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001357
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001358cluster-secret <secret>
1359 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1360 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1361 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1362 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001363 tokens.
1364
1365 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1366 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1367 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001368
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001369cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001370 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1371 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1372 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1373 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1374 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001375
1376 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1377
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001378 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001379 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1380 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1381 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1382 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1383 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1384 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1385 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001386 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1387 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1388 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1389 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1390 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1391 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001392
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001393 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1394 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1395 on the machine's word size.
1396
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001397 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1398 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001399 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1400 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001401 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001402 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1403 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001404
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001405 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1406 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1407 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1408 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1409 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001410
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001411 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001412 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001413 # first 4 CPUs
1414
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001415 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1416 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001417 # word size.
1418
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001419 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420 # and so on.
1421 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1422 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1423 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001424 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001425
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001426 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1427 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1428 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1429 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001430
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001431 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1432 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1433 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001434
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001435 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1436 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1437 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1438 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1439 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1440
1441 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1442 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1443 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001444 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1445 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1446 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1447 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001448
1449
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001450crt-base <dir>
1451 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001452 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1453 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455daemon
1456 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1457 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001458 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1459 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001461default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001462 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001463 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1464 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1465 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1466 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1467 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1468 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1469 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1470 not start with a slash ('/'):
1471 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1472 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1473
1474 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1475 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1476 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1477 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1478 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1479 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1480 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1481 each of them.
1482
1483 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1484 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1485 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1486 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1487 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1488 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1489 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1490 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1491
1492 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1493 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001494 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001495 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1496 made easily relocatable.
1497
1498 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1499 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1500 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1501 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1502 consistent across all configuration files.
1503
1504 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1505 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1506 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1507 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1508 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1509 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1510 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1511 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1512
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001513description <text>
1514 Add a text that describes the instance.
1515
1516 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1517 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1518 "<" and ">" characters.
1519
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001520deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1521 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001522 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001523
1524deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001526 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1527
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001528deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001529 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1530 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1531 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001532
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001533deviceatlas-separator <char>
1534 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1535 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1536
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001537expose-experimental-directives
1538 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1539 the config file will be rejected.
1540
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001541external-check [preserve-env]
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001542 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1543 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001544 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1545 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1546 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001547 By default, the checks start with a clean environment which only contains
1548 variables defined in the "external-check" command in the backend section. It
1549 may sometimes be desirable to preserve the environment though, for example
1550 when complex scripts retrieve their extra paths or information there. This
1551 can be done by appending the "preserve-env" keyword. In this case however it
1552 is strongly advised not to run a setuid nor as a privileged user, as this
1553 exposes the check program to potential attacks. See "option external-check",
1554 and "insecure-fork-wanted", and "insecure-setuid-wanted" for extra details.
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001555
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001556fd-hard-limit <number>
1557 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1558 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1559 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1560 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1561 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1562 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1563 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1564 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1565 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1566 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1567 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1568 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1569
1570 global
1571 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1572 fd-hard-limit 50000
1573
1574 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1575
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001576gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001577 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1579 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001580 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001581 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001582 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001583
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001584grace <time>
1585 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1586
1587 Arguments :
1588 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1589 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1590 soft-stop operation.
1591
1592 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1593 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1594 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1595 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1596 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1597 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1598 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1599 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1600 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1601
1602 Example:
1603
1604 global
1605 grace 10s
1606
1607 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1608 frontend ext-check
1609 bind :9999
1610 monitor-uri /ext-check
1611 monitor fail if { stopping }
1612
1613 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1614 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1615 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1616 SIGUSR1 signal.
1617
1618 Example:
1619
1620 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1621 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1622 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1623 frontend ext-check
1624 bind :9999
1625 monitor-uri /ext-check
1626 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1627
1628 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1629
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001630group <group name>
1631 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1632 See also "gid" and "user".
1633
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001634h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1635 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1636
1637 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1638 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1639 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1640 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1641 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1642 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1643 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1644
1645 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1646 option may be set.
1647
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001648h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1649 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1650 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1651 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1652 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001653 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001654 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1655 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1656 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1657 specified in a proxy.
1658
1659 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1660 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1661 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1662 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1663 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1664 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1665 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1666
1667 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1668 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1669 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1670 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1671 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1672
1673 Example:
1674 global
1675 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1676
1677 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1678 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1679
1680h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1681 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1682 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1683 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1684 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1685 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1686 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1687 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1688 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1689
1690 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1691 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1692 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1693
1694 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1695 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1696
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001697h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1698 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1699 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1700 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1701 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1702 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1703 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1704 the keyword with "no'.
1705
1706hard-stop-after <time>
1707 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1708
1709 Arguments :
1710 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1711 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1712 SIGUSR1 signal.
1713
1714 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1715 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1716 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1717
1718 Example:
1719 global
1720 hard-stop-after 30s
1721
1722 See also: grace
1723
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001724insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001725 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001726 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1727 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1728 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1729 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1730 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1731 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1732 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001733 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001734 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1735 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1736 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1737 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1738 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1739 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1740 disable it.
1741
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001742insecure-setuid-wanted
1743 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1744 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1745 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1746 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001747 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001748 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001749 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001750 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1751 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001753 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1754 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1755 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1756 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1757
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001758issuers-chain-path <dir>
1759 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1760 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1761 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001762 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001763 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1764 "issuers-chain-path".
1765 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1766 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1767 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1768 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1769 will share the chain in memory.
1770
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001771limited-quic
1772 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1773 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1774 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1775 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1776 when this setting is set.
1777
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001778localpeer <name>
1779 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1780 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1781 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1782 the configuration parsing.
1783
1784 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1785 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1786
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001787log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001788 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001789 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001790 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001791 configured with "log global".
1792
1793 <address> can be one of:
1794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001795 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001796 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1797 port).
1798
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001799 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1800 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1801 port).
1802
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001803 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001804 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1805 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001806 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001807
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001808 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1809 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1810 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1811 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1812 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1813 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1814 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1815 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1816 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1817 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001818 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001819 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1820 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1821 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001822 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1823 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001824
1825 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1826 "fd@2", see above.
1827
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001828 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1829 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1830 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1831 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1832 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1833
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001834 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1835 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001836
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001837 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1838 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1839 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1840 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1841 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1842 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1843 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1844 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1845 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1846 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001847 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1848 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001849
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001850 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1851 one of the following :
1852
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001853 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1854 field is stripped. This is the default.
1855 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1856 rfc3164.
1857
1858 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001859 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1860
1861 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1862 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1863
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001864 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1865 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1866 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1867 designed to be used with a local log server.
1868
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001869 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1870 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1871 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1872 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1873 logger consumes.
1874
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001875 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1876 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1877 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1878 used with a local log server.
1879
1880 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1881 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1882 designed to be used with a local log server.
1883
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001884 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1885 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1886 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1887 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1888
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001889 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1890 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1891 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1892 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1893 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1894
1895 <sample_size>
1896 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1897 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1898 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1899 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1900 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1901
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001902 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001903
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001904 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1905 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1906 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1907
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001908 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1909 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1910 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1911 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001912
1913 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001914 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1915 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1916 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1917 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1918 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1919 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001920
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001921 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001922
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001923log-send-hostname [<string>]
1924 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1925 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1926 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1927 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1928 the logs.
1929
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001930log-tag <string>
1931 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1932 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1933 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001934 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001935
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001936lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001937 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1938 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1939 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1940 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1941 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1942 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001943 used multiple times.
1944
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001945 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001946 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001947 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001948 other files.
1949
1950 local args = table.pack(...)
1951
1952lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001953 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1954 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1955 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1956 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1957 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1958 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1959 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1960 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1961 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1962 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1963 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1964 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1965 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1966 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1967 times.
1968
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001969 See lua-load for usage of args.
1970
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001971lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1972 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1973 variable.
1974 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1975 to "path".
1976
1977 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1978 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1979 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1980 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1981 will be checked earlier.
1982
1983 As an example by specifying the following path:
1984
1985 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1986 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1987
1988 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1989 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1990 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1991 paths if that does not exist either.
1992
1993 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1994 documentation.
1995
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001996master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001997 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1998 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1999 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002000 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002001 or daemon mode.
2002
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002003 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2004 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2005 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2006 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2007 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002008
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002009 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002010
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002011mworker-max-reloads <number>
2012 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002013 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002014 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2015 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2016 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2017
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002018nbthread <number>
2019 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002020 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2021 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2022 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2023 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2024 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2025 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2026 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002027
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002028no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002029 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2030 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2031 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2032
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002033numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002034 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2035 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2036 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2037 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2038 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2039 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2040 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2041 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2042 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2043 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002044
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002045pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002046 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2047 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2048 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2049 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002050
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002051pp2-never-send-local
2052 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2053 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2054 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2055 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2056 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2057 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2058 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2059 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2060 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2061 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2062 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2063
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002064presetenv <name> <value>
2065 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2066 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2067 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2068 and "unsetenv".
2069
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002070prealloc-fd
2071 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2072 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2073 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2074 to expand its data structures.
2075
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002076resetenv [<name> ...]
2077 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2078 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2079 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2080 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2081 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2082 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2083 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2084 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2085
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002086server-state-base <directory>
2087 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002088 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2089 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002090
2091server-state-file <file>
2092 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2093 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2094 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2095 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2096 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2097 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2098 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2099 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002100 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2101 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002102
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002103set-dumpable
2104 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2105 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2106 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2107 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2108 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2109 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2110 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2111 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2112 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2113 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2114 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2115 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2116 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2117 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2118 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2119 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2120 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2121 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2122
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002123set-var <var-name> <expr>
2124 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2125 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2126 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2127 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2128 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2129 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002130 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002131 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2132 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2133
2134 Example:
2135 global
2136 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2137 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2138 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2139
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002140set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2141 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2142 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2143 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2144 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2145 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2146 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2147 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2148 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2149 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2150 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2151
2152 Example:
2153 global
2154 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2155 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2156
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002157setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2158 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2159 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2160 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2161 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2162 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2163 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2164 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2165 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2166 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2167 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2168 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2169 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2170 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2171 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2172
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002173setenv <name> <value>
2174 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2175 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2176 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2177 and "unsetenv".
2178
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002179ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2181 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002182 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002183 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002184 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2185 information and recommendations see e.g.
2186 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2187 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2188 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2189 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002190
2191ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2194 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2195 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2196 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2199 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002200 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002201
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002202ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2204 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2205 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2206 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2207 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2208 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2209 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2210 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2211 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2212 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2213 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2214 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2215 with a middlebox is required.
2216
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002217ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2219 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2220 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2221 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2222 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2223
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002224ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2226 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2227 keyword to see available options.
2228
2229 Example:
2230 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002231 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002232
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002233ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2235 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2236 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2237 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2238 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2239 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2240 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2241 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2242 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2243 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2244 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2245 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2246 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2247 with a middlebox is required.
2248
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002249ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2251 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002252 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002253 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002254 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2255 information and recommendations see e.g.
2256 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2257 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2258 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2259 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2260 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002261
2262ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2264 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2265 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2266 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2267 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002268 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2269 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2270 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2271 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002272
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002273ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2275 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2276 keyword to see available options.
2277
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002278ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2280 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2281 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002282 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002283 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002284 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002285 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2286 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2287 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2288 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002289 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2290 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2291 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2292
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002293ssl-propquery <query>
2294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2295 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2296 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2297 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2298 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2299 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2300 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2301 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2302 was not found.
2303
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002304ssl-provider <name>
2305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2306 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2307 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2308 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2309 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2310 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002311
2312 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002313 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2314 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2315 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2316 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2317 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002318
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002319 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2320 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2321 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2322 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002323
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002324 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2325
2326ssl-provider-path <path>
2327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2328 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2329 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2330 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2331 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2332 defined.
2333 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002334
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002335ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2336 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2337 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002338 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002339 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002340 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2341
2342 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002343
2344 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2345 and won't try to remove them.
2346
2347 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2348
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002349ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002350 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002351 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2352 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2353 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002354
2355 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2356 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2357 optimize the startup time.
2358
2359 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2360 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2361 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2362
2363 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002364 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002365
2366 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002367 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2368 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002369
2370 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2371 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2372 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2373 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2374 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002375 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002376
2377 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002378 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002379 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2380 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2381 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2382 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2383 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002384 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002385
2386 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2387
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002388 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002389 a cert bundle.
2390
2391 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2392 separately in several "crt".
2393
2394 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2395 since files are loading separately.
2396
2397 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2398 required to commit them.
2399
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002400 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002401 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002402
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002403 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2404 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2405 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002406
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002407 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2408 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2409 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002410
2411 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002412 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2413 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002414
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002415 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2416 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2417
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002418 The default behavior is "all".
2419
2420 Example:
2421 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2422 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2423 ssl-load-extra-files none
2424
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002425 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2426 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002427
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002428ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2429 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2430 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2431 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2432
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002433ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002434 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002435 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2436 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2437 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2438 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2439 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2440 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002441 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002442
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002443stats maxconn <connections>
2444 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2445 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2446
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002447stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2448 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2449 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2450 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002451 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002452 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002453
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002454 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2455 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2456 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002457
2458stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2459 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2460 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002461 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002462
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002463strict-limits
2464 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2465 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2466 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2467 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2468 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002469
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002470thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2471 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2472 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2473 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2474 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2475 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2476 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2477 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2478 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2479 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2480
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002481thread-groups <number>
2482 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2483 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002484 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2485 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2486 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2487 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2488 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002489
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002490trace <args...>
2491 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2492 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2493 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2494 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2495 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2496 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2497 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2498 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2499 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2500 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2501 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2502 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2503 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2504 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2505 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2506 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2507 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002509uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002510 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002511 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2512 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2513 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2514
2515ulimit-n <number>
2516 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2517 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002518 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2519 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002520
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002521 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2522 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2523 manually specify this value.
2524
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002525 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2526
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002527unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2528 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2529
2530 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2531 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2532 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2533 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2534 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002535 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002536 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2537 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2538 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2539 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2540
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002541unsetenv [<name> ...]
2542 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2543 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2544 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2545 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2546 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2547 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2548 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002550user <user name>
2551 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2552 See also "uid" and "group".
2553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002554node <name>
2555 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2556
2557 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2558 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2559 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2560 traffic.
2561
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002562wurfl-cache-size <size>
2563 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2564 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2565 - "0" : no cache is used.
2566 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002567
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002568 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2569 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002570
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002571wurfl-data-file <file path>
2572 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2573 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2574
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002575 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002576 with USE_WURFL=1.
2577
2578wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2579 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2580 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2581 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2582
2583 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2584
2585 Valid WURFL properties are:
2586 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2587
2588 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2589 device.
2590
2591 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2592 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2593
2594 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2595 particular web request.
2596
2597 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2598 used Libwurfl API version.
2599
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002600 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2601 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2602
2603 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2604 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2605
2606 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2607
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002608 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002609 with USE_WURFL=1.
2610
2611wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2612 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2613 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2614
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002615 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002616 with USE_WURFL=1.
2617
2618wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2619 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2620 thus before the chroot.
2621
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002622 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002623 with USE_WURFL=1.
2624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002626-----------------------
2627
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002628busy-polling
2629 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2630 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2631 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2632 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2633 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2634 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2635 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2636 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2637 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2638 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2639 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2640 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2641 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2642 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2643 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2644 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2645 "poll" pollers.
2646
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002647 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2648 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2649 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2650
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002651max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002652 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002653 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2654 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2655 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2656 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2657 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2658 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2659 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2660
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002661maxcompcpuusage <number>
2662 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2663 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2664 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2665 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2666 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2667 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2668 and from introducing high latencies.
2669
2670maxcomprate <number>
2671 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2672 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2673 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2674 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2675 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2676 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2677 default value.
2678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002679maxconn <number>
2680 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2681 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2682 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002683 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2684 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2685 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2686 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002687 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2688 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2689 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2690 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2691 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002692 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2693
2694 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002695
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002696maxconnrate <number>
2697 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2698 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2699 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2700 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2701 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2702 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2703 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2704 fairness.
2705
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002706maxpipes <number>
2707 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2708 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2709 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2710 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2711 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2712 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2713
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002714maxsessrate <number>
2715 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2716 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2717 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2718 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2719 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2720 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2721 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2722 fairness.
2723
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002724maxsslconn <number>
2725 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2726 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2727 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2728 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2729 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2730 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2731 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002732 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2733 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2734 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2735 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002736 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002737 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2738 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002739
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002740maxsslrate <number>
2741 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2742 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2743 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2744 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2745 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2746 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2747 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2748 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2749 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2750 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2751
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002752maxzlibmem <number>
2753 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2754 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2755 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002756 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2757 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2758 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2759
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002760no-memory-trimming
2761 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2762 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2763 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2764 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2765 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2766 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2767 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2768 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2769 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2770 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2771 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2772 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2773 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2774 not suffer from such a problem.
2775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002776noepoll
2777 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2778 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002779 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002780
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002781noevports
2782 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2783 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2784 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2785 also "nopoll".
2786
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002787nogetaddrinfo
2788 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2789 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2790
2791nokqueue
2792 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2793 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2794 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002796nopoll
2797 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2798 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002800 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2801 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002802
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002803noreuseport
2804 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2805 command line argument "-dR".
2806
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002807nosplice
2808 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002809 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002810 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002811 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002812 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2813 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2814 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2815 "option splice-response".
2816
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002817profiling.memory { on | off }
2818 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2819 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2820 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2821 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2822 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2823 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2824 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2825 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2826 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2827
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002828profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2829 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2830 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2831 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2832 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002833 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002834 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2835 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2836 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2837 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2838
2839 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2840 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2841 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2842 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2843 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002844 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2845 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2846 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2847 CLI.
2848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002856
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002857ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002858 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002859 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002860 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002861 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002862 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2863 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2864 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002865 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2866 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002867 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2868 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2869 openssl configuration file uses:
2870 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2871
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002872 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2873 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2874 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2875 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2876
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002877ssl-mode-async
2878 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002879 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002880 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2881 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002882 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002883 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002884 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002885
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002886tune.buffers.limit <number>
2887 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2888 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2889 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2890 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2891 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002892 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002893 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2894 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2895 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2896 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2897 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2898 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2899 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2900 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002901 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002902
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002903tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2904 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2905 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2906 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002907 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002908
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002909tune.bufsize <number>
2910 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2911 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2912 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2913 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2914 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2915 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2916 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002917 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2918 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002919 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002920 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002921 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002922 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2923 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002924
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002925tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2926 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2927 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2928 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2929 this value. The default value is 1.
2930
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002931tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2932 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2933 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2934 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2935 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2936 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2937 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2938 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2939 appear on a line before this directive.
2940
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002941tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002942 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2943 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2944 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002945 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2946 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2947 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002948
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002949tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2950 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2951 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2952 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2953 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2954 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2955
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01002956tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold <number>
2957 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a backend connection, where
2958 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
2959 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
2960 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
2961 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 servers may
2962 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
2963 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
2964 effective without affecting slightly bogus servers.
2965
2966 See also: tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold, bc_glitches
2967
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02002968tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
2969 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
2970 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
2971 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
2972 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
2973 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
2974 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
2975 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02002976
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02002977 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
2978
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02002979tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2980 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
2981 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
2982 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
2983 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
2984 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
2985 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
2986 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
2987 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
2988 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
2989 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
2990 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
2991 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
2992
Willy Tarreau92f287b2024-03-11 07:33:44 +01002993tune.h2.fe.glitches-threshold <number>
2994 Sets the threshold for the number of glitches on a frontend connection, where
2995 that connection will automatically be killed. This allows to automatically
2996 kill misbehaving connections without having to write explicit rules for them.
2997 The default value is zero, indicating that no threshold is set so that no
2998 event will cause a connection to be closed. Beware that some H2 clientss may
2999 occasionally cause a few glitches over long lasting connection, so any non-
3000 zero value here should probably be in the hundreds or thousands to be
3001 effective without affecting slightly bogus clients.
3002
3003 See also: tune.h2.be.glitches-threshold, fc_glitches
3004
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003005tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3006 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3007 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3008 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3009 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3010 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3011 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3012 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3013 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3014 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003015 parallel to large uploads.
3016
3017 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003018
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003019tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3020 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3021 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3022 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3023 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3024 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3025 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3026 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3027 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3028
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003029tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3030 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3031 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3032 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3033 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3034 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3035 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3036 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3037 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3038 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3039 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3040 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3041 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3042 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3043
3044 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3045 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3046 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3047 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3048 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3049 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3050 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3051 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3052 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3053 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3054
3055 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3056 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3057 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3058 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3059 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3060 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3061 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3062 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3063
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003064tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3065 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3066 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3067 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3068 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3069 change it.
3070
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003071tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003072 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3073 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3074 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3075 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3076 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3077 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3078 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3079 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3080 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3081 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003082
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003083tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003084 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003085 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003086 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3087 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3088 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3089 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3090 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3091 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3092 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003093
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003094tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003095 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003096 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003097 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003098 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3099 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3100 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3101 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3102
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003103tune.http.cookielen <number>
3104 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3105 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3106 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3107 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3108 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3109 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3110 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3111 to change this value.
3112
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003113tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003114 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3115 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003116 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003117 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003118 configuration directives too.
3119 The default value is 1024.
3120
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003121tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3122 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3123 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3124 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3125 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3126 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3127 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003128 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3129 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3130 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003131
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003132tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3133 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3134 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3135 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3136 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3137 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3138 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003139 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3140 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3141 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3142 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3143 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003144
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003145tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003146 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003147 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3148 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3149 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3150 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003151 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003152 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003153 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003154 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3155
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003156tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3157 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3158 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3159 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3160 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3161 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3162 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3163 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3164 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3165 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3166 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3167 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3168 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3169 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3170 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3171 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3172 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3173 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3174 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3175 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3176 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3177 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003178 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3179 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003180
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003181tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3182 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3183 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3184 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003185 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3186 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003187 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3188 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3189 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3190 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3191 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3192 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3193 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3194 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3195 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003196 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003197 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003198
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003199tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3200 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003201 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003202 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3203 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003204 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003205 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3206 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3207
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003208tune.lua.maxmem
3209 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3210 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3211 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3212 memory.
3213
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003214tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3215 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003216 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3217 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003218 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003219
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003220tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3221 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3222 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3223 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3224 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3225 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3226 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3227 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3228
3229 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3230 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3231 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3232 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3233 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3234 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3235
3236 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3237 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3238 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3239 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3240 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3241 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3242
3243 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3244 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3245 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3246 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3247 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3248 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3249 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3250
3251 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3252 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3253
3254 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3255 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3256 time will also be accounted for.
3257
3258 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3259 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3260 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3261 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3262
3263 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3264 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3265 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3266 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3267
3268 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3269
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003270tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3271 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3272 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3273 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003274 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003275
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003276tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3277 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3278 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3279 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3280 check servers.
3281
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003282tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3283 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3284 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3285
3286 Defaults to 'on'.
3287
3288tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3289 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3290 stderr.
3291 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3292
3293 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3294 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3295 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3296
3297 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3298 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3299
3300 Defaults to 'on'.
3301
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003302tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003303 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3304 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003305 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3306 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3307 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3308 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3309 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3310 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3311 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3312 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3313 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003314
3315tune.maxpollevents <number>
3316 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3317 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3318 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3319 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3320 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3321
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003322tune.maxrewrite <number>
3323 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3324 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3325 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3326 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3327 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3328 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3329 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3330 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3331 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3332 bufsize.
3333
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003334tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3335 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3336 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3337 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3338 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3339 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3340 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3341 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3342 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3343 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3344 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3345 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3346 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3347 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3348 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3349
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003350tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3351 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3352 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3353 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3354 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3355 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3356 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3357 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3358 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3359 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003360 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3361 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003362 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3363 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3364 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3365 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3366 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3367 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3368 setting this parameter to 0.
3369
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003370tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3371 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3372 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3373 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3374 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3375 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3376 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3377 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3378
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003379tune.pipesize <number>
3380 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3381 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3382 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3383 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3384 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3385 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3386
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003387tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3388 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003389 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003390 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3391 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3392 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3393 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003394 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003395
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003396tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3397 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003398 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003399 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3400 default is 20.
3401
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003402tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003403 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3404 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3405 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3406 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003407 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003408
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003409tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003410 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3411 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3412 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3413 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3414 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3415 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3416 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3417
3418 The default value is 30000.
3419
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003420tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003421 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3422 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3423 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3424 requests.
3425
3426 The default value is 100.
3427
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003428tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003429 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3430 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3431
3432 The default value is 10.
3433
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003434tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3435 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3436 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3437
3438 The default value is 50.
3439
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003440tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003441 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003442 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3443 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003444 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3445 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003446 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3447 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003448
3449 The default value is 100.
3450
3451 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3452 information about QUIC retry.
3453
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003454tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003455 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3456 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3457 own socket.
3458
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003459 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3460 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003461 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003462 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3463 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3464 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003465 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003466 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3467 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003468 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3469 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003470
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003471 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3472 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3473 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003474 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003475 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003476
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003477tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3478tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3479 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3480 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3481 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003482 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003483 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003484 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3485 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3486
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003487tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003489 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3490 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3491 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3492 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3493
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003494tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003495 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003496 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3497 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3498 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3499 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3500 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3501 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3502 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003503
3504tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003506 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003507 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3508 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3509 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3510 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3511 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3512 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3513 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003514
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003515tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3516tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3517 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3518 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3519 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003520 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003522 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3523 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3524 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3525 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003526 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003527
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003528tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003529 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003530 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3531 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3532 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3533 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3534 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3535 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3536 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3537 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3538 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003539 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3540 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003541
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003542tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3543tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3544 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3545 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3546 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3547 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3548
3549tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3550 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3551 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3552 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3553 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3554 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3555 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3556 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3557 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3558 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3559 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3560 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3561 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3562
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003563tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003564 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003565 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3566 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3567 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3568 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3569 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3570
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003571tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3572 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3573 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3574 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3575 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3576
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003577tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3578 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3579 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3580 performances. This is disabled by default.
3581
3582 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3583 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3584
3585 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3586
3587 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3588
3589 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3590
3591 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3592 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3593 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3594
3595 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3596 converted.
3597
3598 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3599 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3600 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3601 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3602 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3603 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3604 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003605 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3606 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003607
3608 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3609
3610 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3611 only need this line:
3612
3613 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3614
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003615tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3616 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003617 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003618 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3619 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3620 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3621 being used for too long.
3622
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003623tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003624 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3625 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3626 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3627 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3628 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3629 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3630 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3631 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3632 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3633 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3634 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3635 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3636 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003637
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003638tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3639 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3640 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3641 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3642 1000 entries.
3643
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003644tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3645 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3646 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3647 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3648 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3649
3650tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3651 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3652 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3653 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3654 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3655 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3656 information about the auto update mechanism.
3657
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003658tune.stick-counters <number>
3659 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3660 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003661 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003662 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3663 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3664 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3665 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3666 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3667 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3668 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3669 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3670 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3671 entirely disable stick-counters).
3672
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003673tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003674tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003675tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3676tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3677tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003678 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3679 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3680 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3681 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3682 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3683 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3684 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3685 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003686
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003687 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3688 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3689 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3690 all available space is consumed.
3691 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3692 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3693 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003694
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003695tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3696 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003697 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003698 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003699 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003700 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3701
3702tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3703 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3704 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003705 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3706 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037083.3. Debugging
3709--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003710
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003711anonkey <key>
3712 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3713 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3714 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003715 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3716 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003717
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003718quick-exit
3719 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3720 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3721 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3722 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3723 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3724 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3725 do so by developers.
3726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003727quiet
3728 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3729 line argument "-q".
3730
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003731zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003732 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003733 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3734 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3735 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3736 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3737 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3738
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037403.4. Userlists
3741--------------
3742It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3743http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3744it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3745
3746userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003747 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003748 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3749
3750group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003751 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003752 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3753 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3754
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003755user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3756 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003757 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3758 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003759 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3760 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3761 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3762 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003763
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003764 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3765 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3766 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3767 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3768 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3769 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3770 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003771 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003772 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003773
3774 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003775 userlist L1
3776 group G1 users tiger,scott
3777 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003779 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3780 user scott insecure-password elgato
3781 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003782
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003783 userlist L2
3784 group G1
3785 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003786
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003787 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3788 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3789 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003790
3791 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003792
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003793
37943.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003795----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003796It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003797several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003798instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003799values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3800type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3801values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3802active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3803switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3804present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3805watch it.
3806
3807Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3808known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3809the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3810process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3811during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3812tables.
3813
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003814Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3815that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3816each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003817
3818peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003819 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003820 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3821
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003822bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3823bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003824 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3825 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3826
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003827disabled
3828 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3829 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3830 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3831
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003832default-bind [param*]
3833 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3834
3835default-server [param*]
3836 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3837
3838 Arguments:
3839 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3840 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003841 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3842 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3843 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3844 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003845
3846 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3847
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003848enabled
3849 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3850 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003851
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003852log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003853 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3854 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3855 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3856 more details.
3857
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003858peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3859peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003860 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3861 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003862 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003863 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3864 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3865 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003866 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003867
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003868 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003869 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3870
3871 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003872 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3873 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3874 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003875
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003876 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3877 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003878
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003879 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3880 "server" keyword explanation below).
3881
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003882server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3883server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003884 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003885 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003886 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3887 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3888 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003889
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003890 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3891 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3892 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3893 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3894 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003896 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003897 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003898 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003899 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3900 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3901 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003902
3903 backend mybackend
3904 mode tcp
3905 balance roundrobin
3906 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3907 stick on src
3908
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003909 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3910 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003911
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003912 Example:
3913 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003914 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3915 default-server ssl verify none
3916 server haproxy1 #local peer
3917 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3918 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003919
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003920shards <shards>
3921
3922 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3923 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3924 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3925 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3926 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003927
3928table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3929 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3930
3931 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3932 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003933 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003934 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3935 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3936 "stick-table" keyword).
3937
3938 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3939 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3940 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3941 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3942 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3943 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3944 of the stick-table name as follows:
3945
3946 peers mypeers
3947 peer A ...
3948 peer B ...
3949 table t1 ...
3950
3951 frontend fe1
3952 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3953
3954 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3955 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3956
3957 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3958 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3959 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3960 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3961 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3962 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3963 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3964
3965 peers mypeers
3966 peer A ...
3967 peer B ...
3968 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3969
3970 backend t1
3971 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3972
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003973 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003974 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3975 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3976
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090039773.6. Mailers
3978------------
3979It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3980If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3981in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3982
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003983mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003984 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3985 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3986
3987mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3988 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3989
3990 Example:
3991 mailers mymailers
3992 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3993 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3994
3995 backend mybackend
3996 mode tcp
3997 balance roundrobin
3998
3999 email-alert mailers mymailers
4000 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4001 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4002
4003 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4004 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4005
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004006timeout mail <time>
4007 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4008 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4009 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4010 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4011
4012 Example:
4013 mailers mymailers
4014 timeout mail 20s
4015 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004016
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040173.7. Programs
4018-------------
4019In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4020master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4021managed the same way as the workers.
4022
4023During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4024sequence as a worker:
4025
4026 - the master is re-executed
4027 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4028 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4029 instance of the program
4030
4031During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4032
4033program <name>
4034 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4035 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4036 the management guide).
4037
4038command <command> [arguments*]
4039 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4040 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4041 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4042 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4043
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004044user <user name>
4045 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4046 See also "group".
4047
4048group <group name>
4049 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4050 See also "user".
4051
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004052option start-on-reload
4053no option start-on-reload
4054 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4055 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4056 program section.
4057
4058
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040593.8. HTTP-errors
4060----------------
4061
4062It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4063imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4064several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4065
4066http-errors <name>
4067 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4068 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4069
4070errorfile <code> <file>
4071 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4072
4073 Arguments :
4074 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004075 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004076 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004077
4078 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4079 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4080 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4081 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4082 before any chroot is performed.
4083
4084 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4085
4086 Example:
4087 http-errors website-1
4088 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4089 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4090 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4091
4092 http-errors website-2
4093 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4094 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4095 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4096
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020040973.9. Rings
4098----------
4099
4100It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4101servers or traces.
4102
4103ring <ringname>
4104 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4105
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004106backing-file <path>
4107 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4108 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4109 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4110 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4111 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4112 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4113 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4114
4115 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4116 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4117 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4118 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004119 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4120 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4121 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4122 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4123 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4124 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4125 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4126 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4127 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4128 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4129 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4130 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004131
4132 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4133 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4134 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4135 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4136 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4137 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4138 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4139
4140 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4141 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4142 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4143
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004144description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004145 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004146 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4147
4148format <format>
4149 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4150
4151 Arguments:
4152 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4153 one of the following :
4154
4155 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4156 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4157 designed to be used with a local log server.
4158
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004159 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4160 field is stripped. This is the default.
4161 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4162 rfc3164.
4163
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004164 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4165 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4166 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4167 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4168 is the default.
4169
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004170 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004171 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4172
4173 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4174 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4175
4176 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4177 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4178 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4179 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4180 logger consumes.
4181
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004182 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4183 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4184 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4185 with a local log server.
4186
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004187 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4188 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4189 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4190 used with a local log server.
4191
4192maxlen <length>
4193 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4194 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4195 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4196
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004197server <name> <address> [param*]
4198 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4199 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4200 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4201 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4202 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4203 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4204 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4205 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4206 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004207 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4208 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004209
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004210size <size>
4211 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4212 set to BUFSIZE.
4213
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004214timeout connect <timeout>
4215 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4216
4217 Arguments :
4218 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4219 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4220 as explained at the top of this document.
4221
4222timeout server <timeout>
4223 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4224
4225 Arguments :
4226 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4227 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4228 as explained at the top of this document.
4229
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004230 Example:
4231 global
4232 log ring@myring local7
4233
4234 ring myring
4235 description "My local buffer"
4236 format rfc3164
4237 maxlen 1200
4238 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004239 timeout connect 5s
4240 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004241 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004242
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042433.10. Log forwarding
4244-------------------
4245
4246It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004247HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004248
4249log-forward <name>
4250 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4251
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004252backlog <conns>
4253 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4254 on connections accept.
4255
4256bind <addr> [param*]
4257 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004258 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4259 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4260 syslog protocol over TCP.
4261 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004262 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4263
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004264dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004265 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4266 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4267 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4268 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004269 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004270
4271log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004272log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004273 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4274 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4275 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004276 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004277 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4278 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4279 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004280 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004281
4282 Example:
4283 global
4284 log stderr format iso local7
4285
4286 ring myring
4287 description "My local buffer"
4288 format rfc5424
4289 maxlen 1200
4290 size 32764
4291 timeout connect 5s
4292 timeout server 10s
4293 # syslog tcp server
4294 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4295
4296 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004297 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4298 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004299 # all messages on stderr
4300 log global
4301 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4302 log ring@myring local0
4303 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4304 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4305 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4306 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4307 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004308
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004309maxconn <conns>
4310 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4311 10 is the default.
4312
4313timeout client <timeout>
4314 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4315
Lukas Tribus5c11eb82024-01-30 21:17:44 +000043163.11. HTTPClient tuning
4317-----------------------
4318
4319HTTPClient is an internal HTTP library, it can be used by various subsystems,
4320for example in LUA scripts. HTTPClient is not used in the data path, in other
4321words it has nothing with HTTP traffic passing through HAProxy.
4322
4323httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
4324 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
4325 "default" resolvers section.
4326
4327 Default value is off.
4328
4329httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
4330 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
4331 to resolve.
4332
4333 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
4334 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
4335
4336 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4337 configuration error if it fails to load.
4338
4339httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
4340 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
4341 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
4342 option is "ipv6".
4343
4344httpclient.retries <number>
4345 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
4346 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
4347 in a backend.
4348
4349 Default value is 3.
4350
4351httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
4352 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
4353 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
4354 server line.
4355
4356 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4357 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
4358 will be disabled for the httpclient.
4359
4360 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4361 configuration error if it fails.
4362
4363httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
4364 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
4365 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
4366
4367 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
4368 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
4369
4370 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
4371 configuration error if it fails.
4372
4373httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
4374 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
4375 httpclient.
4376
4377 Arguments :
4378 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4379 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4380 as explained at the top of this document.
4381
4382 The default value is 5000ms.
4383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043844. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004385----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004386
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004387Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004388 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4389 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4390 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4391 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004392
4393A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4394connections.
4395
4396A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4397to forward incoming connections.
4398
4399A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4400parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4401
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004402A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4403ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4404sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4405the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4406explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4407from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4408"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4409for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4410to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4411optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4412are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4413any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4414names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4415that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4416duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004417names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4418is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4419implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4420encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4421adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004422
4423Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4424settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4425of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4426profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4427timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004429All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4430'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4431case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4432
4433Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4434logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4435proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4436However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4437name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4438
4439Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4440and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004441bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4443modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4444arbitrary criteria.
4445
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004446In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4447a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004448the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004449
4450 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4451 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4452 between responses and new requests.
4453
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004454 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4455 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4456 client-facing connection remains open.
4457
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004458 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4459 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004460
4461The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4462frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4463following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004464weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004465
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004466 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004467
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004468 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4469 ----+-----+-----+----
4470 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4471 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004472 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4473 ----+-----+-----+----
4474 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004475
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004476It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004477only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4478within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004479as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004480content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004481and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4482possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004483
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004484There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004485first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004486processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004487second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004488protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4489is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4490new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004491to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004492process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4493already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4494HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4495evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4496one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4497
4498There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4499performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4500tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4501preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4502analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4503HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4504header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4505mitigate this drawback.
4506
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004507There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004508method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4509set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4510in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4511is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4512to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4513above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4514to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4515"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4516frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4517frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4518as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4519upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4520on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4521the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4522upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4523frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4524remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020045264.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4527--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004529The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4530limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4531they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4532limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004534option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004535and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4536with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004537specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4538sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4539anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004541
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004542 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4543------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004544acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004545backlog X X X -
4546balance X - X X
4547bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004548capture cookie - X X -
4549capture request header - X X -
4550capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004551clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4552clitcpka-idle X X X -
4553clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004554compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004555cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004556declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004557default-server X - X X
4558default_backend X X X -
4559description - X X X
4560disabled X X X X
4561dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004562email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004563email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004564email-alert mailers X X X X
4565email-alert myhostname X X X X
4566email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004567enabled X X X X
4568errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004569errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004570errorloc X X X X
4571errorloc302 X X X X
4572-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4573errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004574error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004575force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004576filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004577fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004578hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004579http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004580http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004581http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004582http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004583http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004584http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004585http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004586http-check set-var X - X X
4587http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004588http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004589http-request X (!) X X X
4590http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004591http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004592http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004593id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004594ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004595load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004596log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004597log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004598log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004599log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004600max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004601max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004602maxconn X X X -
4603mode X X X X
4604monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004605monitor-uri X X X -
4606option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4607option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4608option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4609option allbackups (*) X - X X
4610option checkcache (*) X - X X
4611option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4612option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004613option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004614option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4615option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004616-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4617option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004618option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004619option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4620option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004621option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004622option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004623option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004624option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004625option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004626option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004627option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4628option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4629option httpchk X - X X
4630option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004631option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004632option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004633option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004634option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004635option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004636option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4637option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4638option logasap (*) X X X -
4639option mysql-check X - X X
4640option nolinger (*) X X X X
4641option originalto X X X X
4642option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004643option pgsql-check X - X X
4644option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004645option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004646option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004647option smtpchk X - X X
4648option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4649option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4650option splice-request (*) X X X X
4651option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004652option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004653option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4654option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4655-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004656option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004657option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4658option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4659option tcpka X X X X
4660option tcplog X X X X
4661option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004662option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004663external-check command X - X X
4664external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004665persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4666rate-limit sessions X X X -
4667redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004668-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004669retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004670retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004671server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004672server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004673server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004674source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004675srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4676srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4677srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004678stats admin - X X X
4679stats auth X X X X
4680stats enable X X X X
4681stats hide-version X X X X
4682stats http-request - X X X
4683stats realm X X X X
4684stats refresh X X X X
4685stats scope X X X X
4686stats show-desc X X X X
4687stats show-legends X X X X
4688stats show-node X X X X
4689stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004690-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4691stick match - - X X
4692stick on - - X X
4693stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004694stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004695stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004696tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004697tcp-check connect X - X X
4698tcp-check expect X - X X
4699tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004700tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004701tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004702tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004703tcp-check set-var X - X X
4704tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004705tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4706tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4707tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4708tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4709tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4710tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004711timeout check X - X X
4712timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004713timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004714timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004715timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4716timeout http-request X X X X
4717timeout queue X - X X
4718timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004719timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004720timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004721timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004722transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004723unique-id-format X X X -
4724unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004725use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004726use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004727use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004728------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4729 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047324.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4733---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734
4735This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4736
4737
4738acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4739 Declare or complete an access list.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004741 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4742
4743 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4744 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4745 using it.
4746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004747 Example:
4748 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4749 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4750 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004752 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004753
4754
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004755backlog <conns>
4756 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | no
4759 Arguments :
4760 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4761 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004762 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004763
4764 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4765 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4766 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4767 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4768 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4769 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4770 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4771 backlog parameter.
4772
4773 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4774 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4775 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4776
4777 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4778
4779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004780balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004781balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004782 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | no | yes | yes
4785 Arguments :
4786 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4787 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4788 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4789 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4790
4791 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4792 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4793 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4794 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004795 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004796 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004797 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4798 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4799 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4800 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4801 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4802 it, so that you don't worry.
4803
4804 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4805 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4806 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4807 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4808 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4809 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4810 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4811 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004813 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4814 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4815 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4816 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4817 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4818 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4819 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004820 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4821 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4822 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004823
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004824 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004825 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004826 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4827 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004828 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004829 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4830 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4831 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4832 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4833 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004834 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4835 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4836 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4837 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4838 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4839 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004840
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004841 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4842 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4843 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4844 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4845 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4846 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4847 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4848 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4849 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4850 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4851 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4852 changed using "hash-type".
4853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004854 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4855 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4856 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4857 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4858 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4859 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4860 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4861 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004862 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004863 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004864 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4865 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004866 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004868 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4869 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4870 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4871 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4872 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4873 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4874 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4875 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4876 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4877 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4878 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4879 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004880
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004881 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004882 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4883 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4884 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4885 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4886 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4887 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4888 URIs start with a leading "/".
4889
4890 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4891 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4892 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4893 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4894
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004895 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4896 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4897 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004898 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4899 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004901 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004902 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4903
4904 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004905 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4906 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004907 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4908 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4909 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4910 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004911 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004912 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4913 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004914
4915 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4916 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4917 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4918 server will receive the request.
4919
4920 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4921 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4922 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4923 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4924 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004925 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4926 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004927 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4928 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004929
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004930 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4931 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4932 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4933 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4934 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004936 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004937 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4938 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4939 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4940
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004941 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4942 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004943 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4944 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004945
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004946 random
4947 random(<draws>)
4948 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004949 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4950 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4951 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4952 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004953 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4954 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4955 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4956 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4957 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4958 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4959 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4960 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4961 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4962 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4963 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4964 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4965 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4966 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4967 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4968 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4969 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4970 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4971 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4972 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004973
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004974 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004975 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004976 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4977 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004978 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004979 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4980 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4981 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004982 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004983 used instead.
4984
4985 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4986 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4987 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004988 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004989
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004990 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4991 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004992 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4993 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004995 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004996 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4997 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004998
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004999 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
5000 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
5001 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005002
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005003 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05005004 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02005005 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
5006 NTLM relies on.
5007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005008 Examples :
5009 balance roundrobin
5010 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005011 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01005012 balance hdr(User-Agent)
5013 balance hdr(host)
5014 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02005015 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
5016 balance hash var(req.client_id)
5017 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005018
5019 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
5020 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
5021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005022 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005023 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
5024 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
5025 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005026 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005027
5028 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
5029 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
5030 defaults to 16 kB.
5031
5032 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
5033 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
5034
5035 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
5036 Round Robin.
5037
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005038 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005039 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
5040 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5041 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5042
5043 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5044
5045 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005046 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005047 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5048 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5049 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005050
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005051 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005052
5053
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005054bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5055bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005056 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 no | yes | yes | no
5059 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005060 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5061 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5062 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5063 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005064 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
Amaury Denoyelleb19d22e2024-02-15 18:43:44 +01005065 that for UDP, specific OS features are required when binding
5066 on multiple addresses to ensure the correct network interface
5067 and source address will be used on response. In other way,
5068 for QUIC listeners only bind on multiple addresses if running
5069 with a modern enough systems.
5070
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005071 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5072 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5073 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5074 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5075 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5076 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005077 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005078 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5079 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005080 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005081 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5082 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005083 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005084 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5085 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005086 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005087 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005088 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5089 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5090 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005091 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5092 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5093 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5094 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005095 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005096 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005097 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005098 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5099 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5100 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5101 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5102 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005103 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005104 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5105 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005106
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005107 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5108 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5109 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005110
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005111 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5112 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005113 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5114 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5115 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005116 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5117 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5118 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5119 the range.
5120
5121 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5122 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5123 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5124 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5125 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5126 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5127 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005128 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005129 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005131 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005132 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005133 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5134 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5135 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5136 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5137 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5138 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5139
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005140 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5141 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5142 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5143 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005145 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5146 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5147 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5148 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5149 in a frontend.
5150
5151 Example :
5152 listen http_proxy
5153 bind :80,:443
5154 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005155 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005156
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005157 listen http_https_proxy
5158 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005159 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005160
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005161 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5162 bind ipv6@:80
5163 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5164 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5165
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005166 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005167 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005168
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005169 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005170 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005171
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005172 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5173 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5174 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5175 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5176 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5177
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005178 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005179 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005180
5181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005182capture cookie <name> len <length>
5183 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 no | yes | yes | no
5186 Arguments :
5187 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5188 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5189 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5190 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005191 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005192
5193 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5194 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5195 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5196 right if it exceeds <length>.
5197
5198 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5199 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5200 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5201 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5202
5203 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5204 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5205 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5206
5207 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5208 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5209 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005210 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5211 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5212 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005213
5214 Example:
5215 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5216
5217 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005218 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005219
5220
5221capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005222 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5224 no | yes | yes | no
5225 Arguments :
5226 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005227 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005228 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5229 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5230 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5231
5232 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5233 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5234 it exceeds <length>.
5235
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005236 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005237 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5238 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005239 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5240 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5241 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5242 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005243 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005244 environments to find where the request came from.
5245
5246 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5247 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5248 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5249 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005250
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005251 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5252 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5253 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5254 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5255 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005256
5257 Example:
5258 capture request header Host len 15
5259 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005260 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005262 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005263 about logging.
5264
5265
5266capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005267 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5269 no | yes | yes | no
5270 Arguments :
5271 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005272 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005273 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5274 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5275 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5276
5277 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5278 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5279 it exceeds <length>.
5280
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005281 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005282 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5283 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5284 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005285 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5286 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5287 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5288 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005289
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005290 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5291 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5292 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5293 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5294 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005295
5296 Example:
5297 capture response header Content-length len 9
5298 capture response header Location len 15
5299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005300 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005301 about logging.
5302
5303
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005304clitcpka-cnt <count>
5305 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5306 the connection on the client side.
5307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5308 yes | yes | yes | no
5309 Arguments :
5310 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5311
5312 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5313 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005314 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5315 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005316
5317 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5318
5319
5320clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5321 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5322 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5323 client side.
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | no
5326 Arguments :
5327 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5328 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5329 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5330 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5331
5332 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5333 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005334 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5335 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005336
5337 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5338
5339
5340clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5341 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 yes | yes | yes | no
5344 Arguments :
5345 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5346 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5347 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5348 document.
5349
5350 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5351 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005352 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5353 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005354
5355 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5356
5357
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005358compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005359compression algo-req <algorithm>
5360compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005361compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005362 Enable HTTP compression.
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | yes | yes | yes
5365 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005366 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5367 responses (legacy keyword)
5368 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5369 provided).
5370 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5371 responses.
5372 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5373 responses (legacy keyword).
5374 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5375 requests.
5376 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5377 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005378
5379 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005380 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5381 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5382 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005383
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005384 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005385 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005386
5387 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5388 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5389 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5390 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5391 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005392 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005393
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005394 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5395 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5396 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5397 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5398 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5399 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5400 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005401 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005402
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005403 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005404 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005405 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005406 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005407 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005408 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005409 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005410
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005411 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005412 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5413 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005414 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005415 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005416 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5417 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5418 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5419 "multipart"
5420 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5421 header
5422 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5423 and later
5424 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5425 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005426 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005427
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005428 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005429
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005430 Examples :
5431 compression algo gzip
5432 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005433
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005434 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005435
5436compression offload
5437 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5439 no | yes | yes | yes
5440
5441 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5442 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5443 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5444 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5445 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5446 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5447 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5448 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5449 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5450 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5451 then be used for such scenarios.
5452
5453 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5454 option is ignored.
5455
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005456 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5457
5458compression direction <direction>
5459 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5460 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5461 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5462 The default value is "response".
5463
5464 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005465
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005466cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005467 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5468 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005469 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005470 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | no | yes | yes
5473 Arguments :
5474 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5475 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5476 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5477 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5478 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5479 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005480 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005481 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5482 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5483
5484 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005485 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005486 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5487 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5488 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5489 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005490 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5491 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005492 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005493 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5494 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005495
5496 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005497 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005498
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005499 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005500 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005501 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005502 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005503 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5504 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5505 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5506 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5507 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5508 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5509 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005510
5511 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5512 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5513 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5514 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5515 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5516 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5517 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5518 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5519 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005520 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005521 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5522 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5523 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005524
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005525 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5526 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5527 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005528 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5529 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5530 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5531 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005532 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5533 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5534 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005535
5536 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5537 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5538 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5539 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5540 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5541 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5542 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5543 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5544 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5545
5546 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5547 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5548 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5549 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5550 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5551 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5552 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5553 persistence cookie in the cache.
5554 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5555
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005556 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5557 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005558 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005559 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5560 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005561 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005562 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5563 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5564 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5565 they logout.
5566
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005567 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005568 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5569 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5570 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5571
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005572 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005573 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5574 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5575 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5576 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5577 this attribute.
5578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005579 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005580 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005581 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5582 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5583 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5584 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5585 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5586 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005587
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005588 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5589 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5590 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5591 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5592 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5593 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5594 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5595 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005596 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005597 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5598 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5599 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5600 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5601 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5602 the site.
5603
5604 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5605 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5606 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5607 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5608 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5609 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5610 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5611 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5612 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5613 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5614 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5615 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5616 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005617 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005618 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5619 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5620
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005621 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5622 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5623 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5624 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5625 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5626 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5627
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005628 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005629 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5630 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5631 repeated.
5632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005633 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5634 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5635 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5636 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005638 Examples :
5639 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5640 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5641 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005642 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005643
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005644 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005645
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005646
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005647declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5648 Declares a capture slot.
5649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5650 no | yes | yes | no
5651 Arguments:
5652 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5653
5654 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5655 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5656 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5657 for use in the response.
5658
5659 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005660 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005661 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5662
5663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005664default-server [param*]
5665 Change default options for a server in a backend
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 yes | no | yes | yes
5668 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005669 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5670 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5671 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5672 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005674 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005675 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5676
5677 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005678
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005680default_backend <backend>
5681 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | yes | yes | no
5684 Arguments :
5685 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5686
5687 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5688 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5689 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5690 will catch all undetermined requests.
5691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005692 Example :
5693
5694 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5695 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5696 default_backend dynamic
5697
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005698 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005700
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005701description <string>
5702 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5704 no | yes | yes | yes
5705 Arguments : string
5706
5707 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5708 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5709 it describes.
5710 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5711
5712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005713disabled
5714 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5716 yes | yes | yes | yes
5717 Arguments : none
5718
5719 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5720 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5721 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5722 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5723 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5724 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5725 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5726
5727 See also : "enabled"
5728
5729
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005730dispatch <address>:<port>
5731 Set a default server address
5732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5733 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005734 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005735
5736 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5737 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5738 during start-up.
5739
5740 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5741 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5742 possible with normal servers.
5743
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005744 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005745 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5746 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5747 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5748 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5749
5750 See also : "server"
5751
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005752
5753dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5754 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5758
5759 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005760 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005761 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5762 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005763 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005764 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005766enabled
5767 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | yes | yes | yes
5770 Arguments : none
5771
5772 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5773 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5774
5775 See also : "disabled"
5776
5777
5778errorfile <code> <file>
5779 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | yes | yes | yes
5782 Arguments :
5783 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005784 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005785 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005786
5787 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005788 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005789 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005790 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5791 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005792
5793 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5794 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5795 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5796
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005797 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5798
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005799 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5800 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5801 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5802 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5803 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5804 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5805 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5806 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5807 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005809 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5810 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5811 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005812 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5814
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005815 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005816
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005817 Example :
5818 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005819 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005820 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5821 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5822
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005823
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005824errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5825 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5826 section.
5827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5828 yes | yes | yes | yes
5829 Arguments :
5830 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5831
5832 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005833 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005834 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5835 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005836
5837 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5838 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5839 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5840 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5841 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005842 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005843 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5844
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005845 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5846 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005847
5848 Example :
5849 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005850 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005851
5852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005853errorloc <code> <url>
5854errorloc302 <code> <url>
5855 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | yes | yes | yes
5858 Arguments :
5859 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005860 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005861 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005862
5863 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5864 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5865 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5866 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005867 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005868
5869 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5870 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5871 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5872
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005873 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5876 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5877 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5878 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005879 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005880 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5881 request.
5882
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005883 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005884
5885
5886errorloc303 <code> <url>
5887 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5889 yes | yes | yes | yes
5890 Arguments :
5891 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005892 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005893 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005894
5895 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5896 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5897 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5898 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005899 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005900
5901 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5902 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5903 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5904
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005905 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005907 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5908 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5909 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5910 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005911 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005912
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005913 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005914
5915
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005916email-alert from <emailaddr>
5917 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005918 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | yes | yes | yes
5921
5922 Arguments :
5923
5924 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5925
5926 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5927 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5928
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005929 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005930 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5931 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005932
5933
5934email-alert level <level>
5935 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5936 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | yes | yes | yes
5939
5940 Arguments :
5941
5942 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5943 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5944 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5945
5946 By default level is alert
5947
5948 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5949 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5950 for the proxy.
5951
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005952 Alerts are sent when :
5953
5954 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5955 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5956 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5957 is notice or lower
5958 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5959 and a health check status update occurs
5960
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005961 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5962 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005963 section 3.6 about mailers.
5964
5965
5966email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5967 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 yes | yes | yes | yes
5970
5971 Arguments :
5972
5973 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5974
5975 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5976 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5977
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005978 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5979 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005980
5981
5982email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5983 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5984 mailers.
5985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | yes | yes | yes
5987
5988 Arguments :
5989
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005990 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005991
5992 By default the systems hostname is used.
5993
5994 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5995 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5996 for the proxy.
5997
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005998 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5999 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006000
6001
6002email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006003 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006004 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
6005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6006 yes | yes | yes | yes
6007
6008 Arguments :
6009
6010 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
6011
6012 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
6013 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
6014
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09006015 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09006016 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
6017
6018
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006019error-log-format <string>
6020 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
6021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6022 yes | yes | yes | no
6023
6024 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
6025 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
6026 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
6027 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01006028 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
6029
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02006030 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
6031 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6032 string in depth.
6033
6034 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
6035 directives.
6036
6037
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006038force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6039 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
6040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006041 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006042
6043 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6044 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6045 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6046 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6047 marked down for maintenance operations.
6048
6049 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6050 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6051 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6052 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6053 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6054 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6055 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6056 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6057 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6058
6059 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6060 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6061 is used.
6062
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006063 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006064 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006065
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006066
6067filter <name> [param*]
6068 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6070 no | yes | yes | yes
6071 Arguments :
6072 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6073 referenced in section 9.
6074
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006075 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006076 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006077 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6078 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006079
6080 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6081 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6082
6083 Example:
6084 listen
6085 bind *:80
6086
6087 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6088 filter compression
6089 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6090
6091 compression algo gzip
6092 compression offload
6093
6094 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6095
6096 See also : section 9.
6097
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006098
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006099fullconn <conns>
6100 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | no | yes | yes
6103 Arguments :
6104 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6105 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6106
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006107 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006108 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006109 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006110 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6111 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6112 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6113 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6114 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006115 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006116
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006117 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006118 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006119 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6120 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6121 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006123 Example :
6124 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6125 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6126 # connections.
6127 backend dynamic
6128 fullconn 10000
6129 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6130 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6131
6132 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6133
6134
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006135hash-balance-factor <factor>
6136 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | no | no | yes
6139 Arguments :
6140 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6141 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006142 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006143
6144 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6145 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6146 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6147 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6148 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6149 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6150 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6151
6152 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6153 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6154 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6155 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6156 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6157
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006158 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6159 consistent hashing mechanism.
6160
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006161 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6162
6163
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006164hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006165 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | no | yes | yes
6168 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006169 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6170 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006171
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006172 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6173 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6174 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6175 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6176 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6177 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6178 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6179 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6180 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6181 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006182
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006183 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6184 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6185 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6186 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6187 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6188 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6189 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6190 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6191 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6192 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6193 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6194 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6195 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006196 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6197 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006198
6199 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6200
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006201 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006202 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6203 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6204 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006205 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6206 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6207 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006208
6209 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6210 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006211 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6212 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6213 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6214 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6215
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006216 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006217 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6218 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6219 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6220 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6221 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6222 parameter.
6223
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006224 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6225 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6226 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6227 used on strings.
6228
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006229 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6230
6231 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6232 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6233 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6234 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6235 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6236 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6237 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6238 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6239 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6240 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6241 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6242 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006243
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006244 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6245 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6246 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006247
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006248 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006249
6250
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006251http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6252 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6253 ones).
6254
6255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006256 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006257
6258 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6259 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6260 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6261 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6262 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6263 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6264
6265 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6266 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6267 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6268
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006269 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6270 supported:
6271 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6272 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006273 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006274 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006275 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006276 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006277 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6278 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006279 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006280 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6281 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6282 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6283 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6284 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006285 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006286 - set-log-level <level>
6287 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006288 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006289 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6290 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006291 - strict-mode { on | off }
6292 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6293
6294 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006295
6296 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6297 instance.
6298
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006299 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6300 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6301 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6302 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6303 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6304 a defaults section defining such rules.
6305
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006306 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6307 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6308 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006310 Example:
6311 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6312 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6313 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6314
6315http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6316
6317 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006318 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6319 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006320
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006321http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322
6323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6324 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6325
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006326http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6327
6328 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6329 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6330 complete description.
6331
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006332http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6333
6334 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6335 del-acl" for a complete description.
6336
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006337http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006338
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006339 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6340 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006341
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006342http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6343
6344 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6345 del-map" for a complete description.
6346
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006347http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6348 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349
6350 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6351
6352 Example:
6353 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6354
6355 # applied to:
6356 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6357
6358 # outputs:
6359 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6360
6361 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6362
6363http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6365
6366 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6367
6368 Example:
6369 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6370
6371 # applied to:
6372 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6373
6374 # outputs:
6375 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6376
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006377http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6379
6380 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6381 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6382 a complete description.
6383
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006384http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6385http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6386http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6387
6388 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6389 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6390 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6391 description.
6392
6393http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6394 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6395http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6397
6398 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6399 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006400 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006401
6402http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6403
6404 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6405 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6406
6407http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6408
6409 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6410 set-map" for a complete description.
6411
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006412http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006414 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6415 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6416 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6417 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006418
6419http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6420 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6421
6422 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006423 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006424 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006425
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006426http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6427http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006428
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006429 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6430 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6431 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006432
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006433http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006434
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006435 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6436 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006437
6438http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6439
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006440 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6441 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006442
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006443
6444http-check comment <string>
6445 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6446 it fails.
6447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6448 yes | no | yes | yes
6449
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006450 Arguments :
6451 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6452 rule fails.
6453
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006454 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6455 user-friendly error reporting.
6456
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006457 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006458 "http-check expect".
6459
6460
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006461http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6462 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006463 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006464 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | no | yes | yes
6467
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006468 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006469 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6470
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006471 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006472 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006473
6474 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6475 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6476 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6477 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6478
6479 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6480
6481 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6482
6483 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6484
6485 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6486
6487 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6488
6489 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6490 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6491 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6492 is used.
6493
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006494 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6495 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6496 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6497 haproxy -vv.
6498
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006499 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6500
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006501 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6502 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6503 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6504 different ports or with different servers.
6505
6506 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6507 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6508 the port with a "http-check connect".
6509
6510 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6511 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6512 do.
6513
6514 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6515 unset-var or comment rules.
6516
6517 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006518 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6519 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6520 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6521 option httpchk
6522
6523 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006524 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006525 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006526 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006527 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006528 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006529
6530 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6531
6532 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006533
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006535http-check disable-on-404
6536 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006538 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006539 Arguments : none
6540
6541 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6542 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6543 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6544 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6545 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6546 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6547 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6548 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006549 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6550 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006551 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6552 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6553 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006555 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006556
6557
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006558http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006559 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6560 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6561 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006562 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006564 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006565
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006566 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006567 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6568
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006569 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6570 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6571 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6572 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6573 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6574 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6575 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6576 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6577 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6578 result is always conclusive.
6579
6580 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6581 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6582 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006583 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6584 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006585 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6586 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006587 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6588 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6589 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006590
6591 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6592 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006593 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6594 supported :
6595 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6596 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006597 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6598 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6599 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6600 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6601 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006602
6603 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6604 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006605 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6606 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6607 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6608 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006609 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6610
6611 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6612 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6613 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6614 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6615
6616 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6617 informational message reported in logs if an error
6618 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6619 log-format string.
6620
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006621 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006622 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6623 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006624 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6625 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6626 details on the supported keywords.
6627
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006628 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6629 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6630 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6631 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006632
6633 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6634 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6635 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6636 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6637 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6638
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006639 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6640 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6641 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6642 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6643 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6644 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6645 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006646
6647 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006648 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006649 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6650 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6651 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6652 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6653
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006654 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6655 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006656 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6657 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6658 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6659 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6660 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6661 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6662 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6663 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006664 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6665 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6666 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6667 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6668 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6669 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6670 insensitive on the header names.
6671
6672 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6673 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6674 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6675 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6676 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6677 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006678
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006679 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006680 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006681 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6682 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6683 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6684 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6685 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006686 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006687 trace).
6688
6689 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006690 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006691 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6692 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6693 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6694 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6695 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006696 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006697
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006698 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6699 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6700 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6701 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6702 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6703 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6704
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006705 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006706 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006707 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6708 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6709 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6710 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6711 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6712 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6713
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006714 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6715 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6716 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6717 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6718 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006719
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006720 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6721 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6722
6723 Examples :
6724 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006725 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006726
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006727 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6728 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6729
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006730 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006731 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006732
6733 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006734 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006735
6736 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006737 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006738
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006739 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006740 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006741
6742
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006743http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006744 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6745 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006746 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6747 health checks.
6748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | no | yes | yes
6750 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006751 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6752
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006753 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6754 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6755 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6756 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6757 to invent non-standard ones.
6758
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006759 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6760 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6761 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6762 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6763
6764 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6765 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6766 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6767 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006768
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006769 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006770 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006771 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006772 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6773 to add it.
6774
6775 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6776 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6777 to the log-format rules.
6778
6779 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6780 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6781 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006782
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006783 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6785 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6786 request.
6787
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006788 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6789 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6790 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006791 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6792 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6793 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6794 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006795 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006796
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006797 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006798 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6799 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006800
6801 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6802 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6803 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6804 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6805 configured request authority.
6806
6807 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6808 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006810 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006811
6812
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006813http-check send-state
6814 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 yes | no | yes | yes
6817 Arguments : none
6818
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006819 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006820 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006821 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6822 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6823 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006824
6825 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6826 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6827 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6828 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6829 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006830 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6831 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6832 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6833
6834 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6835 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6836 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6837
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006838 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6839 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6840 checked in multiple backends.
6841
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006842 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006843 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6844
6845 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6846 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6847 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6848 one fails.
6849
6850 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6851 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6852 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6853
6854 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6855 server's queue.
6856
6857 Example of a header received by the application server :
6858 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6859 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6860
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006861 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6862 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006863
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006864
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006865http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6866http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006867 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 yes | no | yes | yes
6870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006871 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006872 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6873 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6874 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6875 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6876 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6877 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6878 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6879 and '-'.
6880
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006881 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6882 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006883 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006884 conditions.
6885
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006886 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6887
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006888 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6889 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006891 Examples :
6892 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006893 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006894
6895
6896http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006897 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 yes | no | yes | yes
6900
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006901 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006902 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6903 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6904 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6905 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6906 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6907 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6908 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6909 and '-'.
6910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006911 Examples :
6912 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006914
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006915http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6916 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6917 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6918 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6919 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6921 yes | yes | yes | yes
6922 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006923 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006924 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006925 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006926 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006927
6928 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6929 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6930 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6931 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6932
6933 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6934 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6935 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6936 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6937
6938 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6939 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6940 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6941 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6942 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6943 chroot is performed.
6944
6945 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6946 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6947 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6948 considered.
6949
6950 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6951 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6952 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6953 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6954 considered as a raw string.
6955
6956 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6957 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6958 "content-type".
6959
6960 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6961 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6962 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6963 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6964 evaluated as a log-format string.
6965
6966 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6967 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6968 argument to "content-type".
6969
6970 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6971 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6972 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6973 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6974
6975 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6976 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6977 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6978 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6979 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6980 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6981 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6982 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6983
6984 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6985 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6986 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6987
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006988 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6989 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6990 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6991 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6992 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6993
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006994 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6995 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6996
6997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006998http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006999 Access control for Layer 7 requests
7000
7001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007002 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007003
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007004 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7005 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7006 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7007 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7008 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007009
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007010 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7011 supported:
7012 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7013 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7014 - allow
7015 - auth [realm <realm>]
7016 - cache-use <name>
7017 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7018 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7019 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7020 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7021 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7022 - disable-l7-retry
7023 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7024 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
7025 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
7026 - redirect <rule>
7027 - reject
7028 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7029 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7030 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7031 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7032 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7033 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007034 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007035 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7036 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7037 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7038 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7039 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007040 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007041 - set-dst <expr>
7042 - set-dst-port <expr>
7043 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7044 - set-log-level <level>
7045 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7046 - set-mark <mark>
7047 - set-method <fmt>
7048 - set-nice <nice>
7049 - set-path <fmt>
7050 - set-pathq <fmt>
7051 - set-priority-class <expr>
7052 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7053 - set-query <fmt>
7054 - set-src <expr>
7055 - set-src-port <expr>
7056 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7057 - set-tos <tos>
7058 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007059 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7060 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007061 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007062 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007063 - strict-mode { on | off }
7064 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7065 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7066 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7067 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7068 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7069 - use-service <service-name>
7070 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7071 - wait-for-handshake
7072 - cache-use <name>
7073
7074 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007076 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007077
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007078 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7079 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7080 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7081 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7082 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7083 a defaults section defining such rules.
7084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007085 Example:
7086 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7087 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7088 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007090 http-request allow if nagios
7091 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7092 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7093 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007095 Example:
7096 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7097 acl add path /addacl
7098 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007100 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007102 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7103 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007105 Example:
7106 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7107 acl setmap path /setmap
7108 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007110 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007112 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7113 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007115 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7116 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007118http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007120 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7121 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7122 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7123 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7124 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7125 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7126 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7127 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007129http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007131 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7132 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7133 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7134 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7135 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7136 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7137 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7138 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007140http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007143 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007145http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007147 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7148 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7149 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7150 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7151 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007152
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007153 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7154 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7155 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7156 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7157 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7158 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7159 instead.
7160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007161 Example:
7162 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7163 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007164
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007165http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007166
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007167 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007169http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007172 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7173 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7174 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7175 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7176 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7177 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7178 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7179 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7180 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007182 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7183 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7184 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007185 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7186
7187 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7188 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7189 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7190 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007192http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007194 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7195 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7196 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7197 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7198 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7199 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007200
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007201http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007202
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007203 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7204 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7205 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7206 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7207 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007209http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007211 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7212 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7213 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7214 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7215 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7216 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007217
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007218http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7219http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7220 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7221 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7222 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7223 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007224
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007225 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7226 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7227 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007228 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007229 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7230 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7231 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007232 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007233 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007234
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007235http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7236 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7237 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7238 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7239
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007240http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7241 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007242
7243 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7244 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7245 pointed by <resolvers>.
7246 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7247 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7248 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7249 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7250 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7251 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7252 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7253 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7254 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7255 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007256 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7257 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007258
7259 Example:
7260 resolvers mydns
7261 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7262 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7263 timeout retry 1s
7264 hold valid 10s
7265 hold nx 3s
7266 hold other 3s
7267 hold obsolete 0s
7268 accepted_payload_size 8192
7269
7270 frontend fe
7271 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007272 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007273 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7274
7275 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7276 # which mean DNS resolution error
7277 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7278
7279 default_backend be
7280
7281 backend b_503
7282 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7283 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7284 # 503 error page to end users
7285
7286 backend be
7287 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7288 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7289 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7290 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7291 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7292
7293 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7294 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7295
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007296http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7297
7298 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7299 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7300 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7301 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007302 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7303 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007304
7305 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7306
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007307http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007308http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007309http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007310http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007311http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007312http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007313http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007314http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7315http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007316
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007317 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7318
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007319 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007320 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7321 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7322 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7323 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007324
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007325 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7326 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7327 the supported backend.
7328
7329 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7330 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7331 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7332 number of segments in the path.
7333
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007334 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7335 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7336 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7337 when improperly combined.
7338
7339 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7340 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7341 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7342 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7343 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7344
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007345 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007346
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007347 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7348
7349 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7350 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7351
7352 Example:
7353 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7354
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007355 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7356
7357 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7358 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7359
7360 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7361 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7362
7363 Example:
7364 - /#foo -> /
7365
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007366 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7367 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007368
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007369 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7370 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7371
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007372 Example:
7373 - /. -> /
7374 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7375 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7376 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007377
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007378 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7379 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7380
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007381 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007382 their preceding segment.
7383
7384 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7385 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7386
7387 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7388 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007389
7390 Example:
7391 - /foo/../ -> /
7392 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7393 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7394 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007395 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007396 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007397 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007398
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007399 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7400 removed as well:
7401
7402 Example:
7403 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7404 - /bar/../../ -> /
7405
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007406 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7407 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007408
7409 Example:
7410 - // -> /
7411 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7412
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007413 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7414 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7415
7416 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7417 ".", "_", and "~".
7418
7419 Example:
7420 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7421 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7422 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7423 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7424
7425 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7426 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7427
7428 Example:
7429 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7430 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7431
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007432 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007433 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007434
7435 Example:
7436 - /%6f -> /%6F
7437 - /%zz -> /%zz
7438
7439 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7440 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7441
7442 Example:
7443 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7444
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007445 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007446 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7447 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7448
7449 Example:
7450 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7451 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7452 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007454http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007456 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7457 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7458 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7459 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7460 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007462http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007464 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7465 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7466 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7467 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007468
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007469http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7470 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007471
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007472 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007473 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7474 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7475 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7476 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7477 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007478
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007479 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7480 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7481 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7482 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7483 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007485 Example:
7486 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7487
7488 # applied to:
7489 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7490
7491 # outputs:
7492 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7493
7494 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007495
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007496 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7497
7498 # applied to:
7499 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007500
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007501 # outputs:
7502 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007503
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007504http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7506
7507 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7508 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007509 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7510 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7511 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007512
7513 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7514 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7515 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7516
7517 Example:
7518 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7519 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7520
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007521 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7522 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7523 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7524 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7525
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007526http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7527 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7528
7529 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7530 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7531 query-string are replaced.
7532
7533 Example:
7534 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7535 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7536
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007537http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7538 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7539
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007540 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7541 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7542 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7543 against.
7544
7545 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7546 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7547 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007548
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007549 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7550 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7551 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7552 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7553 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7554 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7555 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7556 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7557 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007558 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7559 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007560
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007561 Example:
7562 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7563 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007564
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007565 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7566 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007568http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7569 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007570
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007571 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7572 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7573 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7574 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007575
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007576 Example:
7577 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007578
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007579 # applied to:
7580 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007581
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007582 # outputs:
7583 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007584
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007585http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7586 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7587 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007588 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7590
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007591 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007592 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7593 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007594 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007595 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007596 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007597 are followed to create the response :
7598
7599 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7600 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7601 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7602 ignored.
7603
7604 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7605 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007606 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007607 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7608 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007609
7610 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7611 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7612 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007613 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007614 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007615
7616 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7617 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7618 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007619 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007620 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007621 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007622
7623 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7624 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7625 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7626 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7627 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7628 as a raw content.
7629
7630 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7631 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7632 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7633 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7634 considered as a raw string.
7635
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007636 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007637 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7638 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7639 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7640
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007641 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7642 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007643 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007644
7645 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7646
7647 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007648 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007649 if { path /ping }
7650
7651 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7652 if { path /favicon.ico }
7653
7654 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7655 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7656 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7657
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007658http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7659 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7660
7661 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7662 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7663 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7664 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7665 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7666 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7667 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7668 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7669 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7670
7671 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7672 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7673 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7674 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7675 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7676 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7677
7678 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7679 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7680 uploaded bytes, etc).
7681
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007682http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7683
7684 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7685 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7686 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7687 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7688 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7689 at this index.
7690 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7691 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007693http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7694http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007696 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7697 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7698 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007699
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007700http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7701 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7702 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7703 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7704 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7705 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7706 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7707 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7708 at this index.
7709 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7710 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7711
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007712http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007714
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007715 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7716 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7717 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7718 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007719
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007720http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7722
7723 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7724 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7725 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7726 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7727 agent name must be used.
7728
7729 Arguments:
7730 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7731
7732 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7733 configuration.
7734
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007735http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7736 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007737
7738 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7739 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7740 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7741 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7742 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7743 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7744 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7745 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7746
7747 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7748 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7749 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7750
7751 Arguments:
7752 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7753 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7754 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7755 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7756
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007757 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7758 bytes.
7759
7760 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7761 milliseconds.
7762
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007763 Example:
7764 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7765 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7766
7767 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007769http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007771 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7772 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7773 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7774 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7775 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007777 Arguments:
7778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7779 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007781 Example:
7782 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7783 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007785 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7786 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007788http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007790 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7791 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7792 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007794 Arguments:
7795 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7796 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007798 Example:
7799 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7800 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007802 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7803 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7804 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007806http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007808 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7809 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7810 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7811 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7812 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007814 Example:
7815 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7816 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7817 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7818 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7819 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7820 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7821 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7822 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7823 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007825http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007826
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007827 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7828 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7829 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7830 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7831 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007833http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007836 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7837 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7838 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7839 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7840 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7841 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7842 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7843 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7844 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007846http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007847
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007848 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7849 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7850 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7851 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7852 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7853 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7854 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007855 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7856 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007858http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007860 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7861 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7862 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007863
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007864http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007866 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7867 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7868 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7869 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7870 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7871 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7872 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7873 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007875http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007877 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7878 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7879 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7880 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7881 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7882 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007884 Example :
7885 # prepend the host name before the path
7886 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007887
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007888http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7889
7890 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7891 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7892 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007894http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007896 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7897 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7898 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7899 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7900 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007902http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007904 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7905 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7906 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7907 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7908 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7909 values have higher priority.
7910 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7911 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7912 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7913 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7914 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007916http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007918 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7919 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7920 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7921 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7922 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7923 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7924 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007926 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007927
7928 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007929 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7930 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007931
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007932http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7933 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7934 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7935 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007936 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7937 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007938
7939 Arguments :
7940 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7941 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007942
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007943 See also "option forwardfor".
7944
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007945 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007946 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7947 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7948
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007949 # After the masking this will track connections
7950 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7951 http-request track-sc0 src
7952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007953 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7954 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7955
7956http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7957
7958 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7959 expression.
7960
7961 Arguments:
7962 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7963 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007964
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007965 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007966 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7967 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7968
7969 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7970 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7971 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7972
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007973http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7975
7976 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7977 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7978 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7979 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7980 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7981
7982 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7983 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7984 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7985 results.
7986
7987 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007988 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7989 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007991http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7992
7993 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7994 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7995 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7996 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7997 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7998 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7999 information from the request.
8000
8001 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
8002
8003http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8004
8005 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
8006 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01008007 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
8008 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
8009 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
8010 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
8011 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008012 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
8013
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008014http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8015http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008016
8017 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
8018 inline.
8019
8020 Arguments:
8021 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
8022 scope. The scopes allowed are:
8023 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
8024 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8025 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
8026 (request and response)
8027 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
8028 processing
8029 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8030 processing
8031 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8032 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8033 and '_'.
8034
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008035 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
8036 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05008037 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008038 conditions.
8039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008040 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8041 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008042
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008043 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8044 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8045
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008046 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008047 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008048 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8049
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008050http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008051
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008052 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8053 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8054 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8055 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8056 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8057
8058 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8059 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8060 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8061 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8062 session tables.
8063
8064 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8065 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8066 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8067 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8068 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8069 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8070 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008071
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008072http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008073
8074 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8075 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8076 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8077 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8078 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008079 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008080 processing.
8081
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008082 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008083 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8084 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8085 rules evaluation.
8086
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008087http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8088http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8089 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8090 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8091 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8092 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008093
8094 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8095 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8096 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008097 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8098 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8099 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8100 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8101 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8102 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008103 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008104 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8105 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8106 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008107 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008108 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8109 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8110 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8111 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8112 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008113
8114http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8115http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8116http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8117
8118 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8119 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008120 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8121 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8122 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8123 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008124 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8125 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8126 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8127 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8128 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8129 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8130 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8131
8132 Arguments :
8133 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8134 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8135 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8136 select which table entry to update the counters.
8137
8138 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8139 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8140 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8141 that table until the session ends.
8142
8143 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8144 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8145 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8146 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8147 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8148 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8149 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8150 useful information.
8151
8152 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8153 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8154 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8155 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8156 checks that make use of it.
8157
8158http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8159
8160 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008161
8162 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008163 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008164
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008165http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8166
8167 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8168 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8169 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8170 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8171 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8172 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8173
8174 Arguments :
8175 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8176
8177 Example:
8178 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8179
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008180http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8181 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8182
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008183 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
8184 following conditions occurs:
8185 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
8186 normally.
8187 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
8188 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
8189 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
8190 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
8191 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
8192 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
8193 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
8194 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
8195 not yet been recieved.
8196
8197 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008198
8199 Arguments :
8200
8201 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8202 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8203
8204 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008205 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs77f35912024-01-28 22:07:32 -07008206 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008207
8208 Example:
8209 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8210
8211 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008213http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008215 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8216 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8217 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008218
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008220http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008221 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8222
8223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008224 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008225
8226 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8227 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8228 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8229 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8230 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8231 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8232
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008233 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8234 supported:
8235 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8236 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8237 - allow
8238 - cache-store <name>
8239 - capture <sample> id <id>
8240 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8241 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8242 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8243 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8244 - redirect <rule>
8245 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8246 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8247 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008248 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008249 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8250 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8251 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8252 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8253 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8254 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008255 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008256 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8257 - set-log-level <level>
8258 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8259 - set-mark <mark>
8260 - set-nice <nice>
8261 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8262 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008263 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8264 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008265 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008266 - strict-mode { on | off }
8267 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8268 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8269 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8270 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8271 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8272
8273 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008275 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008276
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008277 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8278 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8279 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8280 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8281 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8282 a defaults section defining such rules.
8283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008284 Example:
8285 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008287 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008289 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8290 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008292 Example:
8293 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008295 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008296
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008297 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8298 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008300 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8301 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008303http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008304
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008305 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8306 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008308http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008310 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008311 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8312 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008314http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008316 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8317 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008318
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008319http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008320
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008321 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008323http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008325 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8326 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8327 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8328 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8329 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8330 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8331 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008333 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8334 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8335 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8336 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8337 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008338
8339 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8340 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8341 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8342 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008343
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008344http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008345
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008346 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8347 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008348
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008349http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008351 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8352 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008354http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008355
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008356 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8357 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008358
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008359http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8360http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8361 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8362 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8363 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008365
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8367 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8368 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008369 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008370 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8371 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8372 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008373 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008374 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008375
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008376http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008378 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8379 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8380 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8381 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8382 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8383 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008384
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008385http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008387
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008388 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8389 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008391 Example:
8392 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008394 # applied to:
8395 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008397 # outputs:
8398 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008400 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008402http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8403 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008404
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008405 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008406 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008407
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008408 Example:
8409 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008411 # applied to:
8412 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008414 # outputs:
8415 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008416
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008417http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8418 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8419 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008420 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8422
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008423 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8424 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8425 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008426
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008427http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8428 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8429
8430 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8431 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8432 a complete description.
8433
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008434http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008435http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8436http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008437
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008438 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8439 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8440 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8441 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008442
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008443http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008444 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008445http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008447
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008448 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8449 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008450 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008451
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008452http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008454
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008455 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8456 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008457
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008458http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8459 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008460
8461 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8462 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8463 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008465http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008467 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8468 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8469 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8470 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008471
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008472http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8473
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008474 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8475 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008476
8477http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8478
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008479 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8480 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008481
8482http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8483
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008484 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8485 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8486 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008487
8488http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8489
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008490 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8491 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008492
8493http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8494 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8495
8496 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8497 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8498 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8499 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008500
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008501 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008502 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8503 http-response set-status 431
8504 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8505 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008507http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008508
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008509 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008510 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8511 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008512
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008513http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8514http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008515
8516 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008517 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8518 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008519
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008520http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008521
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008522 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8523 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008524 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8525 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008526
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008527http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008528
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008529 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8530 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008531
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008532http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8533http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8534http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008535
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008536 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8537 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8538 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008539
8540http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8541
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008542 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008543 about <var-name>.
8544
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008545http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8546 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8547
8548 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008549 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8550 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008551
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008552
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008553http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8554 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8555
8556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8557 yes | no | yes | yes
8558
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008559 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008560 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8561 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8562 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008563
8564 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8565
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008566 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8567 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8568 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8569 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8570 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8571 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8572 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008573 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008574 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8575 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008576
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008577 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8578 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8579 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8580 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8581 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8582 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8583 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008584 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8585 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8586 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8587 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8588 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8589 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008590
8591 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8592 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8593 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8594 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8595 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8596 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8597 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8598 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008599 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008600 downsides of rare connection failures.
8601
8602 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8603 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8604 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8605 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8606 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8607 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008608 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008609 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8610 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8611 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8612 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8613 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8614
8615 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008616 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8617 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8618 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8619 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008620
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008621 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8622 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008623
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008624 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008625
8626 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8627 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8628 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8629
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008630 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8631 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8632 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8633 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8634 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8635 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8636 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8637 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8638 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8639 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8640 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8641
8642 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8643 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8644 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8645 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8646 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8647
8648 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8649 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008650
8651
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008652http-send-name-header [<header>]
8653 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8655 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008656 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008657 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8658
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008659 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8660 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8661 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8662 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8663 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8664 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8665 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8666 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8667 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8668 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8669 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8670 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8671 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8672 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8673 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8674 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008675
8676 See also : "server"
8677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008678id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008679 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8681 no | yes | yes | yes
8682 Arguments : none
8683
8684 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8685 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8686 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008687
8688
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008689ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8690 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008692 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008693
8694 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8695 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8696 and running).
8697
8698 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8699 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8700 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008701 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008702 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8703
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008704 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8705 "unless" condition is met.
8706
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008707 Example:
8708 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8709 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8710 ignore-persist if url_static
8711
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008712 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8713
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008714load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8715 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8717 yes | no | yes | yes
8718
8719 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8720 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8721 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008722 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008723 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008724 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8725 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8726 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8727
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008728 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008729 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008730 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008731
8732 Arguments:
8733 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8734 named "server-state-file".
8735
8736 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8737 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8738 name is used as a file name.
8739
8740 none don't load any stat for this backend
8741
8742 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008743 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8744 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8745 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008746 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008747 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008748
8749 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8750 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8751
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008752 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008753
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008754 global
8755 stats socket /tmp/socket
8756 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008757
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008758 defaults
8759 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008760
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008761 backend bk
8762 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8763 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008764
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008765
8766 Then one can run :
8767
8768 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8769
8770 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8771
8772 1
8773 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8774 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8775 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8776
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008777 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008778
8779 global
8780 stats socket /tmp/socket
8781 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8782
8783 defaults
8784 load-server-state-from-file local
8785
8786 backend bk
8787 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8788 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8789
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008790
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008791 Then one can run :
8792
8793 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8794
8795 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8796
8797 1
8798 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8799 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8800 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8801
8802 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8803 "show servers state"
8804
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008805
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008806log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008807log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008808 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008809no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008810 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008813
8814 Prefix :
8815 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8816 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8817 prefix does not allow arguments.
8818
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008819 Arguments :
8820 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8821 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8822 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8823 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8824 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8825 parameter.
8826
8827 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8828 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8829
8830 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8831 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8832 standard syslog port).
8833
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008834 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8835 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8836 standard syslog port).
8837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008838 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8839 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8840 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008841 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008842
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008843 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8844 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8845 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8846 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8847 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8848 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8849 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8850 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8851 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8852 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8853 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8854 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008855 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008856 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8857 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8858 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008859 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8860 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008861
8862 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8863 and "fd@2", see above.
8864
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008865 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8866 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8867 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8868 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8869 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8870 having the logs instantly available.
8871
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008872 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8873 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8874 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8875
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008876 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8877 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008878
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008879 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8880 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8881 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8882 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8883 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8884 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8885 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8886 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8887 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8888 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008889 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008890
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008891 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8892 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8893 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8894 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8895 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8896
8897 <sample_size>
8898 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8899 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8900 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8901 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8902 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8903
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008904 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8905 one of the following :
8906
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008907 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8908 field is stripped. This is the default.
8909 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8910 rfc3164.
8911
8912 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008913 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8914
8915 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8916 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8917
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008918 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8919 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8920 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8921 designed to be used with a local log server.
8922
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008923 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8924 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8925 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8926 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8927 systemd logger consumes.
8928
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008929 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8930 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8931 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8932 used with a local log server.
8933
8934 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8935 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8936 designed to be used with a local log server.
8937
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008938 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8939 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8940 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8941 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8942
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008943 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8944
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008945 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8946 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8947 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8948
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008949 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8950 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8951 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8952 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008953
8954 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8955 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8956 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008957 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8958 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8959 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8960 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8961 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008962
8963 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8964
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008965 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8966 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8967 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008968
8969 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8970 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8971 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8972 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8973
8974 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8975 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008976
8977 Example :
8978 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008979 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8980 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8981 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008982 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008983 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8984 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008985 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008986
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008987
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008988log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008989 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008992
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008993 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8994 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8995 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8996 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8997 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008998 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8999 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009001 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
9002 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009003
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02009004log-format-sd <string>
9005 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
9006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | yes | yes | no
9008
9009 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
9010 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
9011 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
9012 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
9013 which covers the log format string in depth.
9014
9015 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
9016 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
9017
9018 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
9019 log format to "rfc5424".
9020
9021 Example :
9022 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
9023
9024
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009025log-tag <string>
9026 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
9027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9028 yes | yes | yes | yes
9029
9030 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
9031 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009032 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01009033 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
9034 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
9035 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
9036 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
9037 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
9038 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009039
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009040max-keep-alive-queue <value>
9041 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
9042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9043 yes | no | yes | yes
9044
9045 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
9046 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
9047 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
9048 servers.
9049
9050 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009051 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009052 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9053 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9054 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009055 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009056 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9057 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9058 picking a different server.
9059
9060 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9061 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9062 even if they have to be queued.
9063
9064 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9065 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9066
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009067max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9068 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9069 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9070 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9072 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009073
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009074maxconn <conns>
9075 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9077 yes | yes | yes | no
9078 Arguments :
9079 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9080 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9081 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9082 closes.
9083
9084 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009085 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009086 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9087 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009088 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9089 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9090 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9091 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009092
9093 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9094 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9095 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9096
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009097 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9098 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009100 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9101
9102
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009103mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009104 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9106 yes | yes | yes | yes
9107 Arguments :
9108 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9109 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9110 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9111 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9112
9113 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9114 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9115 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9116 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9117 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009119 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9120 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9121 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009122
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009123 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009124 defaults http_instances
9125 mode http
9126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009128monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009129 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9131 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009132 Arguments :
9133 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9134 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009135 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009136 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9137 backend and its backup.
9138
9139 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9140 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9141 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9142 servers in a list of backends.
9143
9144 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9145 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9146 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009147 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009148 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9149 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009150 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009151 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9152 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009153
9154 Example:
9155 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009156 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009157 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9158 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9159 monitor-uri /site_alive
9160 monitor fail if site_dead
9161
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009162 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009163
9164
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009165monitor-uri <uri>
9166 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9168 yes | yes | yes | no
9169 Arguments :
9170 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9171 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9172
9173 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9174 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9175 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9176 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9177 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9178 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9179 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9180 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9181
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009182 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009183 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9184 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009185 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9186 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9187 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009188 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9189 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9190 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009191
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009192 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9193 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9194 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9195 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009197 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009198 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009199 frontend www
9200 mode http
9201 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9202
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009203 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009205
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009206option abortonclose
9207no option abortonclose
9208 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | no | yes | yes
9211 Arguments : none
9212
9213 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9214 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9215 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9216 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009217 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009218 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9219 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9220 encountered while delivering the response.
9221
9222 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9223 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9224 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9225 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9226 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9227 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009228 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009229 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009230 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009231 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9232 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9233 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9234
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009235 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9236 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009237 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9238 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9239 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9240 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9241 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9242 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009243 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009244
9245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9247
9248 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9249
9250
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009251option accept-invalid-http-request
9252no option accept-invalid-http-request
9253 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9255 yes | yes | yes | no
9256 Arguments : none
9257
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009258 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009259 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009260 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009261 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9262 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9263 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9264 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9265 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009266 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9267 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9268 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9269 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009270 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009271 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009272 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009273 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9274 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009275 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9276 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009277
9278 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9279 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9280 been confirmed.
9281
9282 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9283 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009284 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9285 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009286 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9287
9288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9290
9291 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9292 stats socket.
9293
9294
9295option accept-invalid-http-response
9296no option accept-invalid-http-response
9297 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9299 yes | no | yes | yes
9300 Arguments : none
9301
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009302 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009303 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009304 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009305 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9306 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9307 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9308 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9309 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009310 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9311 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9312 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009313
9314 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9315 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9316 been confirmed.
9317
9318 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9319 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9320 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9321 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9322
9323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9325
9326 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9327 stats socket.
9328
9329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009330option allbackups
9331no option allbackups
9332 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 yes | no | yes | yes
9335 Arguments : none
9336
9337 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9338 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9339 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9340 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9341 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9342 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9343 order between the backup servers anymore.
9344
9345 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9346 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9347
9348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9350
9351
9352option checkcache
9353no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009354 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9356 yes | no | yes | yes
9357 Arguments : none
9358
9359 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9360 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009361 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009362 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9363 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009364 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009365
9366 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009367 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009368 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009369 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9370 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009371 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009372 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009373 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9374 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009375 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009376 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9377 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009378 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009379 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9380 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9381 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9382 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9383 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9384 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9385 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9386 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9387 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9388
9389 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009390 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9391 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9392 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9393 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009394
9395 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9396 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009397 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009398 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009399
9400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9402
9403
9404option clitcpka
9405no option clitcpka
9406 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9408 yes | yes | yes | no
9409 Arguments : none
9410
9411 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9412 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009413 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009414 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9415
9416 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9417 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9418 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9419 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9420
9421 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9422 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9423 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9424 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9425 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9426
9427 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9428
9429 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9430 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9431 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9432
9433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9435
9436 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9437
9438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009439option contstats
9440 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9442 yes | yes | yes | no
9443 Arguments : none
9444
9445 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9446 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9447 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009448 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009449 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9450 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9451 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9452 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9453 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009454
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009455option disable-h2-upgrade
9456no option disable-h2-upgrade
9457 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9458 connection.
9459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9460 yes | yes | yes | no
9461 Arguments : none
9462
9463 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9464 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9465 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9466 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009467 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9468 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9469 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9470 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9471 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9472 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009473
9474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009476
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009477option dontlog-normal
9478no option dontlog-normal
9479 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9481 yes | yes | yes | no
9482 Arguments : none
9483
9484 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9485 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9486 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9487 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9488 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9489 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9490 logged.
9491
9492 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9493 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9494 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009496 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009497 logging.
9498
9499
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009500option dontlognull
9501no option dontlognull
9502 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9504 yes | yes | yes | no
9505 Arguments : none
9506
9507 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9508 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9509 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9510 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9511 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9512 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009513 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9514 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9515 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009516
9517 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009518 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009519 would not be logged.
9520
9521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9523
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009524 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009525 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009526
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009527option forwarded [ proto ]
9528 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9529 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9530 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9531no option forwarded
9532 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9534 yes | no | yes | yes
9535 Arguments :
9536 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9537 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9538
9539 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9540 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9541
9542 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9543 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9544
9545 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9546 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9547
9548 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9549 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9550
9551
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009552 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009553 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9554
9555 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9556 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9557 underlying servers/applications.
9558 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9559 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9560 issues.
9561
9562 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9563 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9564 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9565
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009566 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009567 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9568 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9569 values to an already existing header).
9570
9571 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9572 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9573
9574 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9575 behavior.
9576 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9577
9578 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009579 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009580
9581 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9582 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9583 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9584 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9585 "unknown".
9586
9587 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9588 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9589 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9590 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9591
9592 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9593 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9594 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9595 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9596 "unknown".
9597
9598 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9599 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9600 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9601 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9602
9603 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9604 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9605 it will be ignored.
9606 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9607 otherwise it will be ignored.
9608
9609 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9610 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9611 it will be ignored.
9612 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9613 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9614
9615 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9616 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9617 it will be ignored.
9618 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9619 otherwise it will be ignored.
9620
9621 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9622 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9623 it will be ignored.
9624 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9625 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9626
9627 Examples :
9628 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9629 # Resulting header would look like this:
9630 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9631 backend www_default
9632 mode http
9633 option forwarded
9634 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9635
9636 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9637 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9638 # ip privacy is a concern)
9639 # Resulting header would look like this:
9640 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9641 backend www_host
9642 mode http
9643 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9644
9645 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9646 # Resulting header would look like this:
9647 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9648 backend www_custom
9649 mode http
9650 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9651
9652 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9653 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9654 # Resulting header would look like this:
9655 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9656 backend www_for_hide
9657 mode http
9658 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9659
9660 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009661
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009662option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009663 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9665 yes | yes | yes | yes
9666 Arguments :
9667 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9668 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009669 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009670 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009671
9672 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9673 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9674 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9675 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9676 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9677 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9678 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009679 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9680 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9681 possible that the client has already brought one.
9682
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009683 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009684 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009685 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009686 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009687 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009688 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009689
9690 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9691 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9692 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9693 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9694 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9695 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009696 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009697
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009698 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9699 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009700 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009701 are under the control of the end-user.
9702
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009703 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009704 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9705 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009706 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9707 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9708 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009710 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009711 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9712 frontend www
9713 mode http
9714 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9715
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009716 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9717 backend www
9718 mode http
9719 option forwardfor header X-Client
9720
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009721 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009722 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009723
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009724
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009725option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9726no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9727 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9729 yes | yes | yes | no
9730 Arguments : none
9731
9732 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9733 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9734 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9735 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9736 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9737 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9738 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9739
9740 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9741 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9742 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9743 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9744 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9745 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9746 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9747 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9748 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9749 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9750
9751 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9752
9753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9755
9756 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9757 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9758
9759
9760option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9761no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9762 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9764 yes | no | yes | yes
9765 Arguments : none
9766
9767 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9768 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9769 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9770 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9771 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9772 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9773 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9774
9775 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9776 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9777 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9778 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9779 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9780 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9781 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9782 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9783 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9784 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9785
9786 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9787
9788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9790
9791 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9792 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9793
9794
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009795option http-buffer-request
9796no option http-buffer-request
9797 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9799 yes | yes | yes | yes
9800 Arguments : none
9801
9802 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9803 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9804 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9805 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9806 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9807 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009808 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9809 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9810 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9811 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009812
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009813 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9814 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009815
9816
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009817option http-ignore-probes
9818no option http-ignore-probes
9819 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9821 yes | yes | yes | no
9822 Arguments : none
9823
9824 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9825 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9826 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9827 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9828 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9829 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9830 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9831 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9832 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009833 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9834 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009835 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9836
9837 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9838 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9839 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9840 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9841 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9842 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9843 are often the only way to detect them.
9844
9845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9847
9848 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9849
9850
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009851option http-keep-alive
9852no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009853 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9854 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9856 yes | yes | yes | yes
9857 Arguments : none
9858
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009859 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009860 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9861 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9862 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9863 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9864 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009865
9866 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9867 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009868 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9869 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9870 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9871 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9872 situations where this option may be useful :
9873
9874 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009875 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009876
9877 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9878 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9879
9880 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009881
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009882 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9883 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9884 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9885 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9886 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9887 not set.
9888
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009889 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009890 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009891
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009892 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009893 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009894
9895
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009896option http-no-delay
9897no option http-no-delay
9898 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9900 yes | yes | yes | yes
9901 Arguments : none
9902
9903 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9904 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9905 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9906 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9907 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9908 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9909 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009910 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009911 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9912 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9913 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9914 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9915 affected.
9916
9917 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9918 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9919 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9920 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9921 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9922 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9923 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9924 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9925 latency environments.
9926
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009927 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9928
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009929
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009930option http-pretend-keepalive
9931no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009932 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9933 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009935 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009936 Arguments : none
9937
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009938 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009939 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9940 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9941 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9942 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9943 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9944 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009945
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009946 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009947 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009948 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009949 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009950 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009951 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9952
9953 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9954 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9955 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9956 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009957 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9958 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009959 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9960
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009961 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9962 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9963 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009964 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009965
9966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9968
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009969 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009970 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009971
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009972option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9973 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9974 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9976 yes | yes | yes | yes
9977 Arguments :
9978 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9979 with no FastCGI application configured.
9980
9981 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9982 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9983 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9984
9985 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9986 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9987
9988 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9989 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9990 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9991 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9992 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9993 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9994 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9995 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9996
9997 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9998 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009999
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010000option http-server-close
10001no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010002 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10004 yes | yes | yes | yes
10005 Arguments : none
10006
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010007 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010008 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10009 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10010 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10011 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
10012 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
10013 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
10014 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
10015 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
10016 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
10017 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
10018 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
10019 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
10020 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010021
10022 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
10023 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
10024 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
10025 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010026 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
10027 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010028
10029 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
10030 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010031 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
10032 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
10033 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010034
10035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10037
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010038 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
10039 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +010010040
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010041option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010042no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010043 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
10044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10045 yes | yes | yes | no
10046 Arguments : none
10047
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000010048 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010049 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
10050 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10051 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10052 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10053 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010054 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010055
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010056 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010057 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010058 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10059 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10060 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010061
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010062 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10063 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10064 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10065 front of an existing proxy.
10066
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010067 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10068
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010069 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010070
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071option httpchk
10072option httpchk <uri>
10073option httpchk <method> <uri>
10074option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010075 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | no | yes | yes
10078 Arguments :
10079 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10080 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10081 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10082 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10083 ones.
10084
10085 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10086 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10087 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10088
10089 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10090 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10091 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010092 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010093
10094 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10095 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10096 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10097 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10098 the lack of any response.
10099
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010100 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10101 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10102 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10103 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10104
10105 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10106 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10107 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010108
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010109 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10110 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010111 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010112 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010113 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010114
10115 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010116 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10117 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10118 backend https_relay
10119 mode tcp
10120 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10121 http-check send hdr Host www
10122 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010123
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010124 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10125 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10126 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010127
10128
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010129option httpclose
10130no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010131 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10133 yes | yes | yes | yes
10134 Arguments : none
10135
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010136 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010137 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10138 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10139 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10140 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010141
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010142 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010143 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10144 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010145 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10146 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10147 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010148
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010149 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010150 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10151 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010152
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010153 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010154 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010155
10156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10158
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010159 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010160
10161
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010162option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010163 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010165 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010166 Arguments :
10167 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10168 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10169 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010170 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010171 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010172
10173 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10174 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10175 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10176 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10177 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10178 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10179 ports.
10180
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010181 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10182 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010183
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010184 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010186 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010187
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010188option httpslog
10189 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10191 yes | yes | yes | no
10192
10193 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10194 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10195 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10196 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10197 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10198 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10199 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10200
10201 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10202
10203 See also : section 8 about logging.
10204
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010205
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010206option independent-streams
10207no option independent-streams
10208 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10210 yes | yes | yes | yes
10211 Arguments : none
10212
10213 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10214 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10215 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10216 receive data or not.
10217
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010218 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010219 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10220 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10221 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10222 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10223 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10224 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10225 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10226 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10227 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10228 socket buffers.
10229
10230 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10231 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10232 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10233 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10234 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10235
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010237
10238
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010239option ldap-check
10240 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10242 yes | no | yes | yes
10243 Arguments : none
10244
10245 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10246 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10247 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10248 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10249
10250 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10251 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10252
10253 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10254 configure it.
10255
10256 Example :
10257 option ldap-check
10258
10259 See also : "option httpchk"
10260
10261
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010262option external-check
10263 Use external processes for server health checks
10264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10265 yes | no | yes | yes
10266
10267 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10268 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10269 command".
10270
10271 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10272
10273 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10274
10275
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010276option idle-close-on-response
10277no option idle-close-on-response
10278 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10280 yes | yes | yes | no
10281 Arguments : none
10282
10283 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10284 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10285 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10286 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10287 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10288 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10289 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10290 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10291 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10292
10293 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10294 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10295
10296 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10297 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10298 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10299 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10300
10301 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10302 "hard-stop-after"
10303
10304
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010305option log-health-checks
10306no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010307 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10309 yes | no | yes | yes
10310 Arguments : none
10311
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010312 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10313 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10314 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010315
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010316 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10317 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10318 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10319 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10320 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10321
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010322 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010323 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010324
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010325 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10326 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10327 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010328
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010329
10330option log-separate-errors
10331no option log-separate-errors
10332 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 yes | yes | yes | no
10335 Arguments : none
10336
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010337 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010338 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10339 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10340 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10341 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10342 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10343 provides very important information.
10344
10345 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10346 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10347 error logs.
10348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010349 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010350 logging.
10351
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010352
10353option logasap
10354no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010355 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10357 yes | yes | yes | no
10358 Arguments : none
10359
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010360 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10361 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10362 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10363 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10364
10365 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10366 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10367 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10368 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10369 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010370 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010371 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10372 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10373 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10374 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010375 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010376
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010377 Examples :
10378 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10379 mode http
10380 option httplog
10381 option logasap
10382 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10383
10384 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10385 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10386 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10387 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010389 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010390 logging.
10391
10392
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010393option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010394 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10396 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010397 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010398 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10399 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010400 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10401 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010402
10403 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10404 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010405 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010406 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010407 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10408 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10409 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010410
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010411 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10412 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10413 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010414
10415 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010416 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010417 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10418 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10419 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10420 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10421 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10422 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10423 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10424
10425 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10426 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010427
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010428 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010429
10430 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10431 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10432 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10433 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010434 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010435 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010436
10437 See also: "option httpchk"
10438
10439
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010440option nolinger
10441no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010442 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010445 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010447 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010448 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10449 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10450 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10451 connections.
10452
10453 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10454 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010455 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10456 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10457 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10458 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10459 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10460 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10461 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10462 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10463 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10464 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10465 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10466 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10467 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010468
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010469 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10470 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10471 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10472 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10473 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010474
10475 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10476 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010477 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010478 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010479 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010480
10481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10483
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010484 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10485 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010486
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010487option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10488 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10490 yes | yes | yes | yes
10491 Arguments :
10492 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10493 matching <network>
10494 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10495 header name.
10496
10497 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10498 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10499 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10500 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10501 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10502 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10503 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10504 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10505 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10506 possible that the client has already brought one.
10507
10508 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10509 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10510 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10511 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10512 header and requires different one.
10513
10514 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10515 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10516 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010517 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10518 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10519 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10520 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10521 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010522
10523 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10524 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10525 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10526 both are defined.
10527
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010528 Examples :
10529 # Original Destination address
10530 frontend www
10531 mode http
10532 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10533
10534 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10535 backend www
10536 mode http
10537 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010539 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010540
10541
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010542option persist
10543no option persist
10544 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010548
10549 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10550 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10551 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10552 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10553 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10554 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10555 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10556 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10557 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10558 redirected to another valid server.
10559
10560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10562
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010563 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010564
10565
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010566option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010567 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10569 yes | no | yes | yes
10570 Arguments :
10571 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10572 PostgreSQL server.
10573
10574 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10575 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10576 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10577 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10578
10579 See also: "option httpchk"
10580
10581
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010582option prefer-last-server
10583no option prefer-last-server
10584 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10586 yes | no | yes | yes
10587 Arguments : none
10588
10589 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010590 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010591 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10592 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010593 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010594 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010595 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010596 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10597 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010598 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010599 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010600 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10601 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10602 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010603 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10604 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10605 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010606
10607 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10608 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10609
10610 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10611
10612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010613option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010614option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010615no option redispatch
10616 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10618 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010619 Arguments :
10620 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10621 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10622 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010623 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010624 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010625 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010626 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10627 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10628 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010630
10631 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10632 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10633 be able to access the service anymore.
10634
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010635 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10636 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010637
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010638 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10639 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10640 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10641 following order:
10642
10643 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10644
10645 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10646 list, or
10647
10648 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10649
10650 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10651 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10652
10653 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10654 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10655 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10656 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10657
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010658 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010659 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10660 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10664
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010665 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010666
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010667
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010668option redis-check
10669 Use redis health checks for server testing
10670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10671 yes | no | yes | yes
10672 Arguments : none
10673
10674 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10675 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10676 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10677 find the "+PONG" response message.
10678
10679 Example :
10680 option redis-check
10681
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010682 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010683
10684
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010685option smtpchk
10686option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10687 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10689 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010690 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010691 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010692 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010693 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10694
10695 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10696 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10697 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10698
10699 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10700 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10701 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10702 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10703 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10704 dead server.
10705
10706 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10707 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010709 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10710
10711 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10712 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10713 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10714 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010715 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010716
10717 Example :
10718 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10719
10720 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010723option socket-stats
10724no option socket-stats
10725
10726 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10728 yes | yes | yes | no
10729
10730 Arguments : none
10731
10732
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010733option splice-auto
10734no option splice-auto
10735 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10737 yes | yes | yes | yes
10738 Arguments : none
10739
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010740 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010741 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010742 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010743 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010744 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010745 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10746 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10747 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10748 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10749
10750 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10751 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10752 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10753 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10754 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10755 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10756 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10757 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10758 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10759 keyword.
10760
10761 Example :
10762 option splice-auto
10763
10764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10766
10767 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10768 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10769
10770
10771option splice-request
10772no option splice-request
10773 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10775 yes | yes | yes | yes
10776 Arguments : none
10777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010778 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010779 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010780 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10781 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10782 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10783 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10784
10785 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10786
10787 Example :
10788 option splice-request
10789
10790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10792
10793 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10794 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10795
10796
10797option splice-response
10798no option splice-response
10799 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10801 yes | yes | yes | yes
10802 Arguments : none
10803
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010804 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010805 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010806 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10807 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10808 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10809 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10810
10811 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10812
10813 Example :
10814 option splice-response
10815
10816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10818
10819 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10820 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10821
10822
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010823option spop-check
10824 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010826 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010827 Arguments : none
10828
10829 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10830 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10831 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10832 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10833
10834 Example :
10835 option spop-check
10836
10837 See also : "option httpchk"
10838
10839
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010840option srvtcpka
10841no option srvtcpka
10842 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10844 yes | no | yes | yes
10845 Arguments : none
10846
10847 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10848 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010849 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010850 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10851
10852 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10853 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10854 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10855 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10856
10857 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10858 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10859 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10860 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10861 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10862
10863 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10864
10865 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10866 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10867 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10868
10869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10871
10872 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10873
10874
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010875option ssl-hello-chk
10876 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10878 yes | no | yes | yes
10879 Arguments : none
10880
10881 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10882 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10883 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10884 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10885 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10886 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10887 hello message.
10888
10889 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10890 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10891 messages, which is appreciable.
10892
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010893 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010894 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10895 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010896
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010897 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10898
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010899
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010900option tcp-check
10901 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10903 yes | no | yes | yes
10904
10905 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10906 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10907
10908 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10909 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10910 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10911
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010912 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010913 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10914 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10915 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10916 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10917 only.
10918
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010919 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010920 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010921 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10922 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10923 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10924
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010925 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10927 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010928 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010929 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10930 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10931 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10932 the respective protocols.
10933 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010934 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010935
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010936 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010937
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010938 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10939 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10940 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10941 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010942
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010943 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10944 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10945 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010946
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010947
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010948 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010949 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010950 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010951 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010952
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010953 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010954 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010955 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010956
10957 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10958 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010959 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010960 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010961 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010962 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010963 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010964 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010965 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10966 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010967 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010968 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10969 tcp-check expect string +OK
10970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010972 (send many headers before analyzing)
10973 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010974 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010975 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10976 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10977 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10978 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010979 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010980
10981
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010982 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010983
10984
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010985option tcp-smart-accept
10986no option tcp-smart-accept
10987 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10989 yes | yes | yes | no
10990 Arguments : none
10991
10992 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10993 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10994 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10995 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10996 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10997 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10998
10999 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
11000 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
11001 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
11002 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
11003
11004 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
11005 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
11006 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011007 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011008
11009 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
11010 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
11011 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
11012
11013 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
11014 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
11015 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
11016
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020011017 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
11018
11019
11020option tcp-smart-connect
11021no option tcp-smart-connect
11022 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
11023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11024 yes | no | yes | yes
11025 Arguments : none
11026
11027 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
11028 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
11029 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
11030 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
11031 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
11032
11033 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
11034 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
11035 complex.
11036
11037 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
11038 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
11039 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
11040
11041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
11042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
11043
11044 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
11045
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011046
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011047option tcpka
11048 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
11049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11050 yes | yes | yes | yes
11051 Arguments : none
11052
11053 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11054 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011055 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011056 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11057
11058 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11059 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11060 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11061 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11062
11063 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11064 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11065 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11066 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11067 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11068
11069 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11070
11071 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11072 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11073 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11074 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11075 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11076 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11077 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11078 backends.
11079
11080 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11081
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011082
11083option tcplog
11084 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011086 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011087 Arguments : none
11088
11089 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11090 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11091 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11092 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11093 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11094 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11095 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11096 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11097
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011098 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011100 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011101
11102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011103option transparent
11104no option transparent
11105 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011107 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011108 Arguments : none
11109
11110 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11111 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11112 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11113 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11114 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11115 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11116 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11117 appropriate server.
11118
11119 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11120 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11121
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011122 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011123 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011125
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011126external-check command <command>
11127 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11129 yes | no | yes | yes
11130
11131 Arguments :
11132 <command> is the external command to run
11133
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011134 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11135
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011136 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011137
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011138 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11139 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11140 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11141 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11142 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11143 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011144
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011145 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11146
11147 Environment variables :
11148 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11149 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11150
11151 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11152
11153 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11154
11155 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11156 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11157 for a UNIX socket).
11158
11159 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11160
11161 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11162
11163 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11164
11165 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11166
11167 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11168
11169 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11170 socket).
11171
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011172 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11173
11174 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11175 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11176 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11177 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11178 TCP server).
11179
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011180 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11181 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11182
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011183 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11184
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011185 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11186 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11187 failed.
11188
11189 Example :
11190 external-check command /bin/true
11191
11192 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11193
11194
11195external-check path <path>
11196 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11198 yes | no | yes | yes
11199
11200 Arguments :
11201 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11202
11203 The default path is "".
11204
11205 Example :
11206 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11207
11208 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11209 "external-check command"
11210
11211
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011212persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011213persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011214 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11216 yes | no | yes | yes
11217 Arguments :
11218 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011219 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11220 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011221
11222 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11223 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011224 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011225 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11226 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11227 forwarded to this server.
11228
11229 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11230 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11231 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011232 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011233 a single "listen" section.
11234
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011235 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11236 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11237 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11238
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011239 Example :
11240 listen tse-farm
11241 bind :3389
11242 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11244 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11245 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11246 persist rdp-cookie
11247 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011248 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011249 balance rdp-cookie
11250 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11251 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11252
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011253 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011254
11255
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011256rate-limit sessions <rate>
11257 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11259 yes | yes | yes | no
11260 Arguments :
11261 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11262 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11263
11264 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11265 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11266 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011267 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011268 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11269 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11270
11271 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11272 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11273 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11274 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11275
11276 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11277 listen smtp
11278 mode tcp
11279 bind :25
11280 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011281 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011282
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011283 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11284 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11285 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011286
11287 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11288
11289
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011290redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11291redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11292redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011293 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11295 no | yes | yes | yes
11296
11297 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011298 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011299
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011301 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011302 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11303 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
11304 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011305
11306 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11307 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11308 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11309 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11310 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011311 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11312 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11313 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
11314 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011315
11316 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11317 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11318 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11319 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11320 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11321 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011322 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011323 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011324 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11325 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
11326 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011327
11328 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011329 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11330 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11331 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011332 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011333 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11334 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11335 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11336 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011337
11338 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011339 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011340
11341 - "drop-query"
11342 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11343 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11344 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11345 with a location-type redirect.
11346
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011347 - "append-slash"
11348 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11349 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11350 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11351 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11352
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011353 - "ignore-empty"
11354 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11355 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11356 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11357 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11358 of known paths using a simple map.
11359
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011360 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11361 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11362 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11363 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11364 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11365 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11366 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11367
11368 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11369 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11370 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11371 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11372 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11373 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11374 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011375
11376 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11377 acl clear dst_port 80
11378 acl secure dst_port 8080
11379 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011380 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011381 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011382 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11383
11384 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011385 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11386 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11387 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011388 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011389
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011390 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11391 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11392 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11393
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011394 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011395 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011396
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011397 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011398 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11399 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11400 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011401
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011402 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11403 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11404 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011406 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011407
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011408
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011409retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011410 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11412 yes | no | yes | yes
11413 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011414 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11415 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011416
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011417 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11418 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11419 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11420 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11421 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011422
11423 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011424 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011425 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011426
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011427 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11428 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11429 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011430
11431 See also : "option redispatch"
11432
11433
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011434retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011435 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11436 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11437 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11439 yes | no | yes | yes
11440 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011441 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11442 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11443 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11444 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11445 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011446
11447 none never retry
11448
11449 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11450 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11451
11452 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11453 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11454 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11455 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11456 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11457 processing the request.
11458
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011459 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11460 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11461 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11462 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11463 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11464 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11465 overflow attack for example).
11466
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011467 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11468 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11469 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11470 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11471 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11472 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11473 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11474 amplify denial of service attacks.
11475
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011476 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11477 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11478 considered to be safe to retry.
11479
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011480 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11481 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11482 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11483 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11484 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011485
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011486 all-retryable-errors
11487 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011488 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11489 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11490 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011491
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011492 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11493 not cumulative.
11494
11495 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11496 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11497 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11498 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11499
11500 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11501 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11502 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11503 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11504 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11505 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11506 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11507 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11508 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11509 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11510 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11511 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11512
11513 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11514 should not use this directive.
11515
11516 The default is "conn-failure".
11517
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011518 Example:
11519 retry-on 503 504
11520
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011521 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11522
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011523server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011524 Declare a server in a backend
11525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11526 no | no | yes | yes
11527 Arguments :
11528 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011529 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011530 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011531
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011532 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11533 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11534 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11535 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011536 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11537 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011538 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011539 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11540 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011541 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11542 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11543 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11544 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11545 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11546 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11547 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011548 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011549 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11550 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11551 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11552 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11553 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11554 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011555 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11556 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011557 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11558 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011559
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011560 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011561 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11562 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11563 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11564 adding this value to the client's port.
11565
11566 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11567 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011568 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011569
11570 Examples :
11571 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11572 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011573 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011574 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11575 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11576 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011577
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011578 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11579 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11580 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11581 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11582 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11583
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011584 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11585 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011586
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011587server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011588 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011589 this backend.
11590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11591 no | no | yes | yes
11592
11593 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11594 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11595 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11596 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11597 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011598
11599 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11600 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11601
11602 global
11603 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11604
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011605 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011606 load-server-state-from-file
11607
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011608 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011609 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011610
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011611server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11612 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11613 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11615 no | no | yes | yes
11616
11617 Arguments:
11618 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11619
11620 <num | range>
11621 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11622 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11623 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11624 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11625
11626 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11627
11628 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11629
11630 <params*>
11631 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11632 keyword.
11633
11634 Examples:
11635 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11636 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11637 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11638
11639 # or
11640 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11641
11642 # would be equivalent to:
11643 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11644 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11645 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11646
11647
11648
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011649source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011650source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011651source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011652 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11654 yes | no | yes | yes
11655 Arguments :
11656 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11657 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011658
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011659 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011660 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11661 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11662 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11663 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11664 supported prefixes are :
11665 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11666 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11667 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011668 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011669 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11670 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011671
11672 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11673 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011674 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11675 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11676 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011677
11678 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11679 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11680 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11681 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11682 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11683 <addr>.
11684
11685 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11686 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11687 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11688 port.
11689
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011690 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11691 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11692 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11693 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011694 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011695 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11696 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11697 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11698 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11699 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11700 HTTP header.
11701
11702 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11703 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011704 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011705 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11706 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11707 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11708 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11709 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11710 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11711 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11712
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011713 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11714 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11715 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11716 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11717 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11718 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11719
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011720 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11721 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11722 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11723 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11724
11725 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11726 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11727 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11728 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11729 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11730 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11731
11732 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11733 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11734 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11735 there are two methods :
11736
11737 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11738 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11739 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11740 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11741 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11742 of the client ranges may be used.
11743
11744 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11745 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11746 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11747 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11748 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11749 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11750 same session.
11751
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011752 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11753 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11754 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011755 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011756
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011757 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11758 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011759
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011760 Examples :
11761 backend private
11762 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11763 source 192.168.1.200
11764
11765 backend transparent_ssl1
11766 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11767 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11768
11769 backend transparent_ssl2
11770 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11771 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11772 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11773
11774 backend transparent_ssl3
11775 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11776 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11777 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11778
11779 backend transparent_smtp
11780 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11781 # with Tproxy version 4.
11782 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11783
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011784 backend transparent_http
11785 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11786 # proxy.
11787 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011789 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011790 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11791
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011792
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011793srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11794 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11795 the connection on the server side.
11796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11797 yes | no | yes | yes
11798 Arguments :
11799 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11800
11801 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11802 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011803 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11804 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011805
11806 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11807
11808
11809srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11810 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11811 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11812 server side.
11813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11814 yes | no | yes | yes
11815 Arguments :
11816 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11817 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11818 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11819 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11820
11821 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11822 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011823 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11824 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011825
11826 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11827
11828
11829srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11830 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11832 yes | no | yes | yes
11833 Arguments :
11834 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11835 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11836 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11837 document.
11838
11839 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11840 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011841 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11842 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011843
11844 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11845
11846
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011847stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11848 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011850 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011851
11852 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11853 matched.
11854
11855 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11856 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11857
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011858 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11859 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11860 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11861 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011862
11863 Example :
11864 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11865 backend stats_localhost
11866 stats enable
11867 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11868
11869 Example :
11870 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11871 backend stats_auth
11872 stats enable
11873 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11874 stats admin if TRUE
11875
11876 Example :
11877 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11878 userlist stats-auth
11879 group admin users admin
11880 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11881 group readonly users haproxy
11882 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11883
11884 backend stats_auth
11885 stats enable
11886 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11887 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11888 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11889 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11890
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011891 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11892 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011893
11894
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011895stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11896 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011898 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011899 Arguments :
11900 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11901
11902 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11903
11904 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11905 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11906 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11907 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11908 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11909 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11910
11911 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11912 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11913 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011914 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011915
11916 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11917 report using "stats scope".
11918
11919 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11920 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11921 unobvious parameters.
11922
11923 Example :
11924 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11925 backend public_www
11926 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11927 stats enable
11928 stats hide-version
11929 stats scope .
11930 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011931 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011932 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11933 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11934
11935 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11936 backend private_monitoring
11937 stats enable
11938 stats uri /admin?stats
11939 stats refresh 5s
11940
11941 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11942
11943
11944stats enable
11945 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011947 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011948 Arguments : none
11949
11950 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11951 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11952 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11953 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11954 - stats auth : no authentication
11955 - stats scope : no restriction
11956
11957 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11958 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11959 unobvious parameters.
11960
11961 Example :
11962 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11963 backend public_www
11964 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11965 stats enable
11966 stats hide-version
11967 stats scope .
11968 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011969 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011970 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11971 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11972
11973 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11974 backend private_monitoring
11975 stats enable
11976 stats uri /admin?stats
11977 stats refresh 5s
11978
11979 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11980
11981
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011982stats hide-version
11983 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011986 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011988 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11989 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11990 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11991 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11992 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11993 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011995 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11996 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11997 unobvious parameters.
11998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011999 Example :
12000 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12001 backend public_www
12002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020012003 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012004 stats hide-version
12005 stats scope .
12006 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012007 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012008 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12009 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012010
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012011 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12012 backend private_monitoring
12013 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012014 stats uri /admin?stats
12015 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010012016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012017 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020012018
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012019
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020012020stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
12021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12022 Access control for statistics
12023
12024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12025 no | no | yes | yes
12026
12027 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
12028 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
12029 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
12030 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
12031 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
12032 should be asked to enter a username and password.
12033
12034 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
12035 instance.
12036
12037 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
12038 about ACL usage.
12039
12040
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012041stats realm <realm>
12042 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
12043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012045 Arguments :
12046 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
12047 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
12048 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
12049
12050 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12051 using a backslash ('\').
12052
12053 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12054 only related to authentication.
12055
12056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12058 unobvious parameters.
12059
12060 Example :
12061 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12062 backend public_www
12063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12064 stats enable
12065 stats hide-version
12066 stats scope .
12067 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012068 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012069 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12070 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12071
12072 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12073 backend private_monitoring
12074 stats enable
12075 stats uri /admin?stats
12076 stats refresh 5s
12077
12078 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12079
12080
12081stats refresh <delay>
12082 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012084 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012085 Arguments :
12086 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12087 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12088 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12089 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12090 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12091 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12092
12093 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12094 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12095 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012096 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012097
12098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12100 unobvious parameters.
12101
12102 Example :
12103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12104 backend public_www
12105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12106 stats enable
12107 stats hide-version
12108 stats scope .
12109 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012110 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12113
12114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12115 backend private_monitoring
12116 stats enable
12117 stats uri /admin?stats
12118 stats refresh 5s
12119
12120 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12121
12122
12123stats scope { <name> | "." }
12124 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012127 Arguments :
12128 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12129 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12130 section in which the statement appears.
12131
12132 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12133 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12134 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12135 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12136 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12137 exists.
12138
12139 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12140 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12141 unobvious parameters.
12142
12143 Example :
12144 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12145 backend public_www
12146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12147 stats enable
12148 stats hide-version
12149 stats scope .
12150 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012151 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012152 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12153 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12154
12155 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12156 backend private_monitoring
12157 stats enable
12158 stats uri /admin?stats
12159 stats refresh 5s
12160
12161 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12162
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012163
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012164stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012165 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012167 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012168
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012169 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012170 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12171
12172 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12173 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12174
12175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012178
12179 Example :
12180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12181 backend private_monitoring
12182 stats enable
12183 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12184 stats uri /admin?stats
12185 stats refresh 5s
12186
12187 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12188 global section.
12189
12190
12191stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012192 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12194 yes | yes | yes | yes
12195 Arguments : none
12196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012197 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012198 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12199 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12200 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12201 - IP (socket, server)
12202 - cookie (backend, server)
12203
12204 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12205 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012206 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012207
12208 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12209
12210
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012211stats show-modules
12212 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12214 yes | yes | yes | yes
12215 Arguments : none
12216
12217 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12218 values as a tooltip.
12219
12220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12222 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12223
12224 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12225
12226
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012227stats show-node [ <name> ]
12228 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012231 Arguments:
12232 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12233 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12234
12235 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12236 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012237 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012238
12239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12241 unobvious parameters.
12242
12243 Example:
12244 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12245 backend private_monitoring
12246 stats enable
12247 stats show-node Europe-1
12248 stats uri /admin?stats
12249 stats refresh 5s
12250
12251 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12252 section.
12253
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012254
12255stats uri <prefix>
12256 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012259 Arguments :
12260 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12261 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12262 query string.
12263
12264 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12265 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12266 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12267 possible to reach it in the application.
12268
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012269 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012270 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012271 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12272 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12273 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12274 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12275
12276 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12277 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12278 an address or a port to statistics only.
12279
12280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12282 unobvious parameters.
12283
12284 Example :
12285 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12286 backend public_www
12287 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12288 stats enable
12289 stats hide-version
12290 stats scope .
12291 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012292 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012293 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12294 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12295
12296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12297 backend private_monitoring
12298 stats enable
12299 stats uri /admin?stats
12300 stats refresh 5s
12301
12302 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12303
12304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012305stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12306 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012308 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012309
12310 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012311 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012312 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012313 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012314 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12315
12316 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12317 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12318 the "stick-table" statement.
12319
12320 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12321 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12322 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12323 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12324 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12325
12326 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12327 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12328 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12329 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12330 transformation rules.
12331
12332 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12333 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12334 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12335 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12336 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12337 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12338 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12339
12340 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12341 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12342 ACL based conditions.
12343
12344 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12345 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12346 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12347 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12348
12349 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12350 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12351 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12352 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12353
12354 Example :
12355 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12356 # last 30 minutes
12357 backend pop
12358 mode tcp
12359 balance roundrobin
12360 stick store-request src
12361 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12362 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12363 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12364
12365 backend smtp
12366 mode tcp
12367 balance roundrobin
12368 stick match src table pop
12369 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12370 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12371
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012372 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12373 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012374
12375
12376stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12377 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12379 no | no | yes | yes
12380
12381 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12382 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12383 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12384 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12385
12386 Examples :
12387 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012388 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012389
12390 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12391 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12392 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12393
12394
12395 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12396 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12397 backend http
12398 mode http
12399 balance roundrobin
12400 stick on src table https
12401 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12402 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12403 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12404
12405 backend https
12406 mode tcp
12407 balance roundrobin
12408 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12409 stick on src
12410 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12411 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12412
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012413 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012414
12415
12416stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12417 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12419 no | no | yes | yes
12420
12421 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012422 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012423 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012424 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012425 server is selected.
12426
12427 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12428 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12429 the "stick-table" statement.
12430
12431 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12432 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12433 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12434 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12435 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12436 address.
12437
12438 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12439 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12440 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12441 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12442 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12443 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12444 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12445 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12446 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12447 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12448
12449 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12450 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12451 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12452 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12453 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12454 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12455 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12456
12457 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12458 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12459 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12460 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12461
12462 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12463 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12464 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12465 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12466 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12467 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012468 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12469 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12470 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12471 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12472 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12473 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012474
12475 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12476 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12477 the request.
12478
12479 Example :
12480 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12481 # last 30 minutes
12482 backend pop
12483 mode tcp
12484 balance roundrobin
12485 stick store-request src
12486 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12487 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12488 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12489
12490 backend smtp
12491 mode tcp
12492 balance roundrobin
12493 stick match src table pop
12494 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12495 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12496
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012497 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012498
12499
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012500stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012501 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012502 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012503 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012505 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012506
12507 Arguments :
12508 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12509 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12510 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12511 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12512
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012513 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12514 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12515 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12516 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12517
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012518 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12519 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12520 instance.
12521
12522 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12523 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12524 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12525 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12526 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12527 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012528 to 32 characters.
12529
12530 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12531 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12532 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012533 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012534 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12535 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012536
12537 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012538 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12539 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012540 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12541 increase.
12542
12543 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012544 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12545 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12546 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012547
12548 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012549 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012550 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12551 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012552 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012553 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12554 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12555 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12556 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12557 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12558 parameter (see below).
12559
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012560 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12561 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12562 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12563 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12564 soft restart.
12565
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012566 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012567 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12568 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012569 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12570 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012571 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012572 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012573 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12574 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012575 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12576 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012577
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012578 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12579 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12580 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12581 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12582 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12583 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12584 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12585 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12586 token.
12587
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012588 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12589 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12590 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12591 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012592 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12593 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12594 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12595 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12596 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12597 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12598 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12599 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12600 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12601 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12602 types and their arguments.
12603
12604 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12605 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12606 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12607 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12608
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012609 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12610 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12611 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12612 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12613 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12614 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12615 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12616 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12617 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12618 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012619 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12620 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12621 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12622 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012623
12624 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12625 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12626 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12627 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12628 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12629 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012630 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12631 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12632 update message can fit into the buffer.
12633 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12634 store only the counter gpc0.
12635 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012636 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12637 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12638 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012639 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12640 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12641 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12642 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012643
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012644 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12645 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12646 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012648
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012649 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12650 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12651 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012653 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012654 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012655
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012656 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12657 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12658 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12659 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12660
12661 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12662 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12663 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12664 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12665 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12666 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12667
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012668 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12669 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12670 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12671 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12672 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012673 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12674 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12675 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12676 to store only the tag gpt0.
12677 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12678 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12679 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012680 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12681 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12682 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012683
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012684 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12685 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12686 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12687 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12688
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012689 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12690 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12691 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12692 they were received.
12693
12694 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12695 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12696 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12697 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12698 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12699
12700 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12701 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12702 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12703 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12704 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12705
12706 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12707 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12708 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12709
12710 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12711 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12712 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12713 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12714 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12715
12716 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12717 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12718 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12719 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12720 the client side.
12721
12722 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12723 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12724 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12725 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12726 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12727 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12728 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12729
12730 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12731 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12732 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12733 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12734 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12735 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012737
12738 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12739 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12740 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12741 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12742 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12743 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12744
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012745 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12746 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12747 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12748 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12749 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12750
12751 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12752 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12753 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12754 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12755 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12756 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12757
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012758 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012759 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012760 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12761 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12762
12763 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12764 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12765 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12766 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12767 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12768 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12769 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12770 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12771 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12772 recommended for better fairness.
12773
12774 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012775 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012776 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12777 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12778
12779 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12780 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12781 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12782 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12783 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12784 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12785 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12786 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12787 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12788 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012789
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012790 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12791 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012792 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12793 reference it.
12794
12795 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12796 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012797 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12798 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12799 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012800
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012801 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12802 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12803 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12804 something that can be ignored.
12805
12806 Example:
12807 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12808 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12809 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12810 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012812 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012813 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012814
12815
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012816stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012817 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12819 no | no | yes | yes
12820
12821 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012822 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012823 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012824 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012825 server is selected.
12826
12827 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12828 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12829 the "stick-table" statement.
12830
12831 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12832 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12833 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12834 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12835
12836 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12837 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12838 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12839 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12840 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12841 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012842 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012843 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12844 rules.
12845
12846 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12847 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12848 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12849 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12850 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12851 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12852 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12853
12854 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12855 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12856 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12857 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12858
12859 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12860 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12861 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12862 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12863 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12864 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012865 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12866 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12867 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12868 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12869 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12870 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12871 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12872 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12873 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012874
12875 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12876
12877 Example :
12878 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12879 backend https
12880 mode tcp
12881 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012882 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012883 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012884
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012885 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012886 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012887
12888 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12889 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12890 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12891
12892 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12893 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012894
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012895 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12896 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12897 # at offset 44.
12898
12899 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012900 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012901
12902 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012903 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012904
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012905 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12906 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12907
12908 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12909 extraction.
12910
12911
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012912tcp-check comment <string>
12913 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12914 it fails.
12915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12916 yes | no | yes | yes
12917
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012918 Arguments :
12919 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12920 rule fails.
12921
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012922 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12923 user-friendly error reporting.
12924
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012925 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12926 "tcp-check expect".
12927
12928
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012929tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12930 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012931 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012932 Opens a new connection
12933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012934 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012935
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012936 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012937 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12938
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012939 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012940 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012941
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012942 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012943 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12944 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012945 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012946
12947 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012948
12949 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12950
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012951 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12952
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012953 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12954
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012955 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12956
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012957 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12958 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12959 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12960 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12961
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012962 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12963 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12964 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12965 haproxy -vv.
12966
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012967 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012968
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012969 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12970 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12971 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12972
12973 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12974 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12975 of the sequence.
12976
12977 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12978 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12979 do.
12980
12981 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12982 unset-var or comment rules.
12983
12984 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012985 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12986 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12987 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12988 option tcp-check
12989 tcp-check connect
12990 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12991 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12992 tcp-check send \r\n
12993 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12994 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12995 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12996 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12997 tcp-check send \r\n
12998 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12999 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
13000
13001 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
13002 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013003 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013004 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13005 tcp-check connect port 143
13006 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13007 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
13008
13009 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
13010
13011
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013012tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013013 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013014 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013015 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013016 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013018 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013019
13020 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013021 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13022
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013023 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
13024 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
13025 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
13026 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
13027 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
13028 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
13029 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
13030 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
13031 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
13032 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
13033
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013034 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013035 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
13036 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013037 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
13038 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
13039 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
13040
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013041 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13042 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
13043 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013044 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
13045 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013046 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13047 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013048 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
13049 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013050 By default "L7OK" is used.
13051
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013052 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13053 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013054 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13055 supported :
13056 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13057 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013058 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13059 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13060 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13061 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13062 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013063
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013064 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013065 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013066 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13067 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13068 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13069 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013070 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13071
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013072 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13073 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13074 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13075 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13076
13077 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13078 informational message reported in logs if an error
13079 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13080 log-format string.
13081
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013082 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13083 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13084 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13085 followed by some converters.
13086
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013087 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13088 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13089 with the usual backslash ('\').
13090 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013091 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013092 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13093 used upper or lower case.
13094
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013095 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13096
13097 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13098 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13099 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13100 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13101 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13102 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13103 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13104 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13105
13106 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13107 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13108 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13109 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13110 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13111 expression.
13112
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013113 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13114 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13115 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13116 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13117 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13118 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13119
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013120 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13121 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13122 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13123 this exact hexadecimal string.
13124 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13125
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013126 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13127 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13128 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13129 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13130 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13131 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13132 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13133 size.
13134
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013135 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13136 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13137 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13138 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13139 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13140 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13141 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13142 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13143 in a binary string before matching the response's
13144 buffer.
13145
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013146 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013147 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013148 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13149 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13150 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13151 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13152 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13153 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13154 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13155 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13156 the null character.
13157
13158 Examples :
13159 # perform a POP check
13160 option tcp-check
13161 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13162
13163 # perform an IMAP check
13164 option tcp-check
13165 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13166
13167 # look for the redis master server
13168 option tcp-check
13169 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013170 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013171 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13172 tcp-check expect string role:master
13173 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13174 tcp-check expect string +OK
13175
13176
13177 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013178 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013179
13180
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013181tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13182tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13183 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13184 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013186 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013187
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013188 Arguments :
13189 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13190
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013191 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13192 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013193
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013194 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13195 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013196
13197 Examples :
13198 # look for the redis master server
13199 option tcp-check
13200 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13201 tcp-check expect string role:master
13202
13203 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013204 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013205
13206
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013207tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13208tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13209 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13210 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013212 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013213
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013214 Arguments :
13215 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013216
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013217 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13218 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013219
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013220 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13221 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13222 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013223
13224 Examples :
13225 # redis check in binary
13226 option tcp-check
13227 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13228 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13229
13230
13231 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013232 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013233
13234
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013235tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13236tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013237 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013239 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013240
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013241 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013242 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13243 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13244 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13245 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13246 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13247 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13248 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13249 and '-'.
13250
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013251 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13252 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013253 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013254 conditions.
13255
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013256 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13257
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013258 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
13259 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
13260
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013261 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013262 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013263 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013264
13265
13266tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013267 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013269 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013270
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013271 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013272 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13273 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13276 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13278 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13279 and '-'.
13280
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013281 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013282 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13283
13284
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013285tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013286 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013288 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013289 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013290 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13291 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013293 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013294
13295 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13296 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013297 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13298 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13299 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13300 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13301 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13302 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013304 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13305 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13306 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013307 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13308 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13309 is true.
13310
13311 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13312 supported:
13313 - accept
13314 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13315 - expect-proxy layer4
13316 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013317 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013318 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13319 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13320 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13321 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13322 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13323 - set-dst <expr>
13324 - set-dst-port <expr>
13325 - set-mark <mark>
13326 - set-src <expr>
13327 - set-src-port <expr>
13328 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013329 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13330 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013331 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013332 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13333 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13334 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013335 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013336
13337 The supported actions are described below.
13338
13339 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13340 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013341
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013342 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13343 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13344 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13345 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13346 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13347 a defaults section defining such rules.
13348
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013349 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13350 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13351 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013352
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013353 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13354 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13355 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013356
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013357 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13358 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13359 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013360
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013361 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13362 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13363 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013364
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013365 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13366 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13367 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013369 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013370
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013371 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013373 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013374
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013375 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013376
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013377tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013378
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013379 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13380 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013381
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013382tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013385 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13386 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13387 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13388 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13389 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13390 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13391 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013393tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013394
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013395 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13396 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13397 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13398 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13399 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13400 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013402tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013403
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013404 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13405 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13406 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13407 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13408 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13409 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13410 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13411 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13412 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13413 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13414 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013415
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013416tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13417 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13418
13419 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13420 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13421 a complete description.
13422
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013423tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13424tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13425tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013426
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013427 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13428 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13429 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13430 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013431
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013432tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13434tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013437 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13438 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013439 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013441tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13442tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013443
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013444 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13445 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13446 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013447
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013448tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013450 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13451 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13452 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013453
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013454tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13455tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013456
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013457 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13458 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13459 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013460
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013461tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013462
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013463 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13464 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13465 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013466
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013467tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13468tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013469
13470 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13471 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13472 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13473 for a complete description.
13474
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013475tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013476
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013477 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13478 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13479 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13480 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013482tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13483tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13484tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013485
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013486 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13487 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13488 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013489
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013490tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13491
13492 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13493 details about variables.
13494
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013495
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013496tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13497 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013499 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013500 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013501 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13502 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013503
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013504 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013505
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013507 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13508 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013509 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13510 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013512 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13513 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13514 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13515 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013516 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013517 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013518 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13519 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13520 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13521 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013522 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013523 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013525 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13526 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13527 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13528 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013529
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013530 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13531 supported:
13532 - accept
13533 - capture <sample> len <length>
13534 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13535 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013536 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013537 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013538 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013539 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013540 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013541 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013542 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013543 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013544 - set-dst <expr>
13545 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013546 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013547 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013548 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013549 - set-priority-class <expr>
13550 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013551 - set-src <expr>
13552 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013553 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013554 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13555 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013556 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013557 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013558 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13559 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13560 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013561 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013562 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013563
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013564 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013565
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013566 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13567 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13568 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13569 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13570 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13571 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013572
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013573 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13574 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13575 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13576 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13577 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13578 a defaults section defining such rules.
13579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013580 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013581 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13582 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013583
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013584 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13585 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13586 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13587 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13588 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13589 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13590
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013591 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013592 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13593 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13594 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13595 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13596 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13597 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13598 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13599 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13600 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13601 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013602
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013603 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013604 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13605 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13606 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013607
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013608 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013609 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013610
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013611 Example:
13612
13613 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013614 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013615 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013616
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013617 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013618 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013619 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013620 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13621 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013622 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013623 tcp-request content reject
13624
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013625 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13626 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13627 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13628 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13629 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13630 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13631 ...
13632 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13633
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013634 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013635 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13636 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013637 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013638 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013639
13640 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13641 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013642 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013643 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013644 tcp-request content reject
13645
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013646 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013647 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013648 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013649 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013650 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13651 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013652
13653 Example:
13654 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13655 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013656 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013657
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013658 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013659 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013660
13661 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013663 # protecting all our sites
13664 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013665 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13666 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013667 ...
13668 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13669
13670 backend http_dynamic
13671 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013672 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013673 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013674 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013675 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013676 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013677 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013679 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013680
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013681 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13682 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013683
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013684tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13685
13686 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013687 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013688
13689tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13691
13692 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13693 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13694 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13695 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13696 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13697 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13698 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13699 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13700 information.
13701
13702tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13703
13704 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13705 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13706 complete description.
13707
13708tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13709
13710 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13711 are evaluated.
13712
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013713tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13714 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13715
13716 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13717 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13718 a complete description.
13719
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013720tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13721tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13722tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13723
13724 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13725 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13726 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13727 description.
13728
13729tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13730 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13731tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13732 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13733
13734 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13735 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013736 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013737
13738tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13739 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13740
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013741 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013742 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13743
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013744tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13745 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013746
13747 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13748 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13749 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13750
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013751tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13752tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13753
13754 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13755 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13756 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13757
13758tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13759
13760 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13761 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13762
13763tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13764
13765 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13766 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13767 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13768
13769tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13770
13771 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13772 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13773
13774tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13775
13776 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13777 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13778
13779tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13780
13781 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13782 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13783 description.
13784
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013785tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13786tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13787
13788 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13789 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13790 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013792tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13793
13794 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13795 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13796 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13797
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013798tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13799tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013800
13801 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13802 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13803 for a complete description.
13804
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013805tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013806
13807 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13808 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13809 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13810 complete description.
13811
13812tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13813 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13814
13815 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13816 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13817 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13818 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13819 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13820 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13821 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13822 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13823 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13824 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13825
13826 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13827
13828tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13829tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13830tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13831
13832 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13833 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13834 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13835
13836tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13837
13838 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13839 details about variables.
13840
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013841tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013842
13843 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13844 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13845 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13846 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13847 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13848
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013849
13850tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13851 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013853 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013854 Arguments :
13855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13857 as explained at the top of this document.
13858
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013859 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013860 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13861 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13862 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13863 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13864
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013865 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13866 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13867 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13868 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13869
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013870 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013871 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013872 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013873 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013874 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013875 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13876 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13877 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013878
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013879 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13880 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13881
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013882 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13883 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13884 it pass through unaffected.
13885
13886 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13887 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13888 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013889 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013890 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13891 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013892 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13893 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13894 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013895
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013896 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13897 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13898
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013899 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013900 "timeout client".
13901
13902
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013903tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13904 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013906 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013907 Arguments :
13908 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13909 below.
13910
13911 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13912
13913 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13914 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13915 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13916 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013917 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013918 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13919 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13920 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13921 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13922 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13923 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13924 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13925 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13926 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13927 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13928 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13929 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13930 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13931 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13932 instead.
13933
13934 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13935 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13936 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13937 rules which may be inserted.
13938
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013939 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13940 supported:
13941 - accept
13942 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013943 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013944 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13945 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13946 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13947 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13948 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013949 - set-dst <expr>
13950 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013951 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013952 - set-src <expr>
13953 - set-src-port <expr>
13954 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013955 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13956 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013957 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013958 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13959 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13960 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13961 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013962
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013963 The supported actions are described below.
13964
13965 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13966 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13967 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13968 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13969 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13970 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013971
13972 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13973 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13974 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13975
13976 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13977 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13978 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13979 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13980 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13981
13982 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13983 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13984
13985 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13986 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13987 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13988
13989 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13990 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13991 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13992
13993 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13994 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13995 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13996
13997 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13998 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13999 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
14000
14001 See section 7 about ACL usage.
14002
14003 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
14004
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014005tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14006
14007 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
14008 rules are evaluated.
14009
14010tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14011
14012 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
14013 are evaluated.
14014
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014015tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14017
14018 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14019 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14020 a complete description.
14021
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014022tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14023tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14024tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14025
14026 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14027 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14028 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14029 description.
14030
14031tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14032 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14033tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14035
14036 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14037 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014038 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014039 description.
14040
14041tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14042tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14043
14044 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
14045 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
14046 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
14047
14048tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14049
14050 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14051 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14052 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14053
14054tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14055tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14056
14057 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14058 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14059 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14060
14061tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14062
14063 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14064 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14065 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14066
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014067tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14068tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014069
14070 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14071 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14072 for a complete description.
14073
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014074tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014075
14076 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14077 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14078 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14079 complete description.
14080
14081tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14082tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14083tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14084
14085 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14086 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14087 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14088
14089tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14090
14091 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14092 details about variables.
14093
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014094
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014095tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14096 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014098 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014099 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014100 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14101 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014102
14103 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014105 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014106 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14107 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014108 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14109 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014110
14111 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14112
14113 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14114 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14115 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14116 inserted.
14117
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014118 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14119 supported:
14120 - accept
14121 - close
14122 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014123 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014124 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14125 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14126 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14127 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14128 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14129 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014130 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014131 - set-log-level <level>
14132 - set-mark <mark>
14133 - set-nice <nice>
14134 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014135 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14136 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014137 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014138 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14139
14140 The supported actions are described below.
14141
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014142 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14143 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14144 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14145 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14146 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14147 a defaults section defining such rules.
14148
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014149 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14150 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14151 for changing the default action to a reject.
14152
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014153 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014155 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14156 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14157 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14158 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14159 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014160
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014161 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014162
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014163 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014164
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014165tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014166
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014167 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14168 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014169
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014170tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014171
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014172 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14173 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14174 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14175 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14176 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14177 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014178
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014179tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014180
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014181 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14182 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014183
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014184tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14185 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14186
14187 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14188 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14189 a complete description.
14190
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014191tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14192tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14193tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014194
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014195 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14196 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14197 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14198 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014199
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014200tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14201 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14202tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014204
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014205 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14206 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014207 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014208
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014209tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14210 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014211
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014212 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014213 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014214
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014215
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014216tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14217 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014218
14219 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14220 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14221 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014223tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014224
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014225 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14226 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014227
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014228tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014229
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014230 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14231 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14232 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014234tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014235
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014236 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14237 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014238
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014239tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014240
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014241 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14242 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14243 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014244
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014245tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14246tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014247
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014248 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14249 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14250 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014251
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014252tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014253
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014254 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14255 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14256 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14257 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014258
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014259tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014260
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014261 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14262 details about variables.
14263
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014264
14265tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14266 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014268 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014269 Arguments :
14270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14272 as explained at the top of this document.
14273
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014274 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14275 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014276
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014277 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14278
14279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014280timeout check <timeout>
14281 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14282 established.
14283
14284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14285 yes | no | yes | yes
14286 Arguments:
14287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14289 as explained at the top of this document.
14290
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014291 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014292 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014293 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014294 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014295 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14296 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14297 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014298
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014299 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014300 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14301
14302 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14303 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014304 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014305
14306 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14307 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14308 forget about it.
14309
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014310 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14311 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014312
14313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014314timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014315 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14317 yes | yes | yes | no
14318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14321 as explained at the top of this document.
14322
14323 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14324 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14325 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014326 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14327 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14328 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14329 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014330 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14331 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14332 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014333 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014334 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014335 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14336 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014337 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14338 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014339
14340 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14341 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14342 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14343 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014344 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014345 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14346
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014347 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014349
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014350timeout client-fin <timeout>
14351 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14353 yes | yes | yes | no
14354 Arguments :
14355 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14357 as explained at the top of this document.
14358
14359 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14360 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14361 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14362 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14363 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14364 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14365 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014366 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14367 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14368 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014369
14370 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14371 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14372 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14373
14374 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14375
14376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014377timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014378 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14380 yes | no | yes | yes
14381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14384 as explained at the top of this document.
14385
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014386 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014387 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014388 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014390 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14391 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014392
14393 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14394 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14395 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14396 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014397 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014398 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14399
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014400 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014402
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014403timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14404 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14406 yes | yes | yes | yes
14407 Arguments :
14408 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14409 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14410 as explained at the top of this document.
14411
14412 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14413 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14414 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14415 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14416 once the request has started to present itself.
14417
14418 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14419 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14420 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14421 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14422 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14423
14424 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14425 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14426 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14427 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14428
14429 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14430 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014432 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14433 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014434 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014435
14436 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14437 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14438 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14439 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14440
14441 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14442
14443
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014444timeout http-request <timeout>
14445 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014449 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014450 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14451 as explained at the top of this document.
14452
14453 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14454 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14455 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14456 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14457 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14458 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14459 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014460 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14461 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14462 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14463 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014464 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014465 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14466 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014467
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014468 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14469 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14470 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14471 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14472 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014473 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014474
14475 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14476 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014478 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14479 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14480
14481 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014482 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14483 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14484 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014485
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014486 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014487 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014489
14490timeout queue <timeout>
14491 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14493 yes | no | yes | yes
14494 Arguments :
14495 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14496 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14497 as explained at the top of this document.
14498
14499 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14500 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14501 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14502 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14503 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14504
14505 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14506 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14507 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14508 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14509
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014510 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014511
14512
14513timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014514 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14516 yes | no | yes | yes
14517 Arguments :
14518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14520 as explained at the top of this document.
14521
14522 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14523 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14524 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14525 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14526 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14527 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14528 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14529
14530 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14531 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14532 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14533 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14534 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014535 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014536 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014537 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14538 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014539 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14540 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014541
14542 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14543 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14544 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14545 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014546 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014547 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14548
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014549 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014550
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014551
14552timeout server-fin <timeout>
14553 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14555 yes | no | yes | yes
14556 Arguments :
14557 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14558 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14559 as explained at the top of this document.
14560
14561 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14562 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14563 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14564 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14565 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14566 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14567 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14568 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14569 situations, it should not be needed.
14570
14571 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14572 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14573 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14574
14575 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14576
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014577
14578timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014579 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14581 yes | yes | yes | yes
14582 Arguments :
14583 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14584 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14585 as explained at the top of this document.
14586
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014587 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14588 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14589 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014590
14591 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14592 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14593 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14594 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014595 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014596
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014597 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014598
14599
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014600timeout tunnel <timeout>
14601 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14603 yes | no | yes | yes
14604 Arguments :
14605 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14606 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14607 as explained at the top of this document.
14608
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014609 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014610 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14611 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14612 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014613 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14614 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014615 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14616 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14617 specified.
14618
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014619 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14620 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14621 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14622 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14623 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14624 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14625 state.
14626
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014627 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14628 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14629 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14630 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014631 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014632
14633 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14634 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14635 forget about it.
14636
14637 Example :
14638 defaults http
14639 option http-server-close
14640 timeout connect 5s
14641 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014642 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014643 timeout server 30s
14644 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14645
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014646 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014647
14648
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014649transparent (deprecated)
14650 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014652 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014653 Arguments : none
14654
14655 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14656 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14657 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14658 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14659 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14660 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14661 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14662 appropriate server.
14663
14664 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14665
14666 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14667 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14668
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014669 See also: "option transparent"
14670
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014671unique-id-format <string>
14672 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14674 yes | yes | yes | no
14675 Arguments :
14676 <string> is a log-format string.
14677
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014678 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14679 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14680 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14681 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014682
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014683 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014684 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014685 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14686 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14687 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14688 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14689 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14690 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014691
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014692 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14693 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014694
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014695 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014696
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014697 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014698
14699 will generate:
14700
14701 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14702
14703 See also: "unique-id-header"
14704
14705unique-id-header <name>
14706 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14708 yes | yes | yes | no
14709 Arguments :
14710 <name> is the name of the header.
14711
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014712 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14713 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014714
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014715 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014716
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014717 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014718 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14719
14720 will generate:
14721
14722 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14723
14724 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014725
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014726use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014727 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14729 no | yes | yes | no
14730 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014731 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14732 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014733
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014734 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14735 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014736
14737 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14738 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14739 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014740 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014741 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014742 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14743 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014744
14745 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14746 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14747 assign the backend.
14748
14749 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14750 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14751 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14752 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14753 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14754 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14755
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014756 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014757 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014758 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14759 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14760 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14761
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014762 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14763 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14764 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14765 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14766 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14767 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14768 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14769 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14770 cannot be forced from the request.
14771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014772 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014773 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14774 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14775
14776 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14777 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014778
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014779use-fcgi-app <name>
14780 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14782 no | no | yes | yes
14783 Arguments :
14784 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14785
14786 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014787
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014788use-server <server> if <condition>
14789use-server <server> unless <condition>
14790 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14792 no | no | yes | yes
14793 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014794 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14795 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014796
14797 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14798
14799 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14800 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14801 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14802
14803 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14804 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14805 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14806 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14807 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14808 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14809 matches will assign the server.
14810
14811 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14812 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14813 with the next rules until one matches.
14814
14815 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14816 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14817 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14818 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14819
14820 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14821 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14822 stripped.
14823
14824 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14825 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014826 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014827 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014828 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014829
14830 Example :
14831 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014832 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014833 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014834 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014835 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014836 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014837 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014838 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14839 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14840
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014841 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14842 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14843 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14844 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014845 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014846 and we fall back to load balancing.
14847
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014848 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014849
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148515. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014852--------------------------
14853
14854The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14855depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14856settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14857written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14858described in this section.
14859
14860
148615.1. Bind options
14862-----------------
14863
14864The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14865as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14866no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14867parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14868while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14869provided immediately after the setting name.
14870
14871The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14872
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014873accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14874 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14875 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14876 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14877 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14878 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14879 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14880 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14881 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14882 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014883 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14884 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14885 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014887accept-proxy
14888 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014889 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14890 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014891 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14892 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14893 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14894 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014896 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14897 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014898 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14899 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014900
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014901allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014902 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014903 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014904 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014905 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14906 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014907
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014908alpn <protocols>
14909 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14910 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14911 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014912 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014913 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014914 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14915 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14916 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14917 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14918 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14919 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14920 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14921 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14922 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14923 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014924
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014925 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014926
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014927 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14928 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014929 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14930 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014931
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014932 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14933 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14934 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14935 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14936 globally.
14937
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014938backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014939 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014940 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14941
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014942curves <curves>
14943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14944 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14945 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14946 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14947 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14948 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14949
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014950ecdhe <named curve>
14951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014952 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14953 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014954
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014955ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14957 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014958 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14959 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014960 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014961
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014962 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14963 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14964 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14965 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14966 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014967 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014968
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014969ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14971 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014972 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14973 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14974 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14975 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14976 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014977 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14978 error is ignored.
14979
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014980ca-sign-file <cafile>
14981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14982 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14983 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14984 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14985 'generate-certificates' for details.
14986
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014987ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14989 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14990 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14991 'generate-certificates' for details.
14992
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014993ca-verify-file <cafile>
14994 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14995 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14996 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14997 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14998 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14999
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015000ciphers <ciphers>
15001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15002 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000015003 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015004 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015005 information and recommendations see e.g.
15006 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15007 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15008 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
15009
15010ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15012 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
15013 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
15014 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015015 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
15016 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015017
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020015018client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
15019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15020 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
15021 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
15022 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15023 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
15024
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015025crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15027 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020015028 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
15029 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015031crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15033 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
15034 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
15035 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
15036 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010015037 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
15038 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015039
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010015040 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
15041 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
15042
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015043 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
15044 are loaded.
15045
15046 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010015047 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020015048 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
15049 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
15050 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15051 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15052 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15053 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15054 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015055 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15056 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015057
15058 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15059 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15060 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15061 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015062 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15063 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015064
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015065 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015066
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015067 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015068 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015069 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15070 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015071 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15072 clients).
15073
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015074 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015075 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15076 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15077 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15078 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15079 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15080 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15081 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15082 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15083 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15084 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15085 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15086 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15087
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015088 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015089 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15090 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15091 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15092 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15093
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015094 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15095 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15096 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15097 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015098
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015099 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15100 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15101 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015102
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015103crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015105 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15106 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15107 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15108 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15109 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15110 in new version of OpenSSL.
15111 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15112 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015113
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015114crt-list <file>
15115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015116 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15117 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015118
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015119 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15120
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020015121 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
15122 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
15123 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
15124 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
15125 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015126
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015127 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015128 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15129 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15130 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15131 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15132 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015133 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15134 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15135 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015136
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015137 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15138 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15139 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015140
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015141 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15142
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015143 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015144 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015145 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15146 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15147 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15148 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15149 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15150 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015151
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015152 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15153 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15154 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15155 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15156 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15157
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015158 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015159 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015160 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015161 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015162 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015163 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015165defer-accept
15166 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15167 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15168 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015169 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015170 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15171 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15172 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15173 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15174 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15175 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15176 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15177
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015178expose-fd listeners
15179 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15180 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015181 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15182 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015183 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015184
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015185force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015186 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015187 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015188 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015189 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015190
15191force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015192 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015193 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015194 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015195
15196force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015197 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015198 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015199 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015200
15201force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015202 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015203 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015204 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015205
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015206force-tlsv13
15207 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15208 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015209 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015210
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015211generate-certificates
15212 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15213 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15214 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15215 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15216 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15217 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15218 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15219 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15220 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15221 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15222 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15223
15224 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15225 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015226 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015227 certificate is used many times.
15228
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015229gid <gid>
15230 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15231 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15232 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15233 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15234 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15235
15236group <group>
15237 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15238 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15239 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15240 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15241 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15242
15243id <id>
15244 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15245 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15246 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15247 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15248
15249interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015250 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15251 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15252 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15253 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15254 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15255 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015256 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15257 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15258 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15259 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15260 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15261 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015262
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015263level <level>
15264 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15265 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15266 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015267 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015268 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15269 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15270 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015271 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015272 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015273 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015274 all counters).
15275
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015276severity-output <format>
15277 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15278 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15279 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15280 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15281 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15282 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15283 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15284 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15285 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15286 rfc5424 convention.
15287
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015288maxconn <maxconn>
15289 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15290 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15291 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15292 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15293 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15294 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15295 eat all memory.
15296
15297mode <mode>
15298 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15299 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15300 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15301 UNIX sockets.
15302
15303mss <maxseg>
15304 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15305 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15306 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15307 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15308 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15309 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15310 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15311 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15312 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15313 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15314 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15315
15316name <name>
15317 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15318 page.
15319
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015320namespace <name>
15321 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15322 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15323 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15324 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15325
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015326nice <nice>
15327 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15328 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15329 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15330 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15331 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15332 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15333 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15334 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15335 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15336 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15337 one for an RDP socket.
15338
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015339no-alpn
15340 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15341 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15342 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015343 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15344 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15345 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15346 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15347 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015348
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015349no-ca-names
15350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15351 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015352 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015353
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015354no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015356 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015357 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015358 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015359 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15360 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015361
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015362no-tls-tickets
15363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15364 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15365 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015366 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15367 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015368 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15369 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15370 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015371
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015372no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015374 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015375 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015376 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015377 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15378 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015379
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015380no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015382 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015383 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015384 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015385 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15386 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015387
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015388no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015389 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015390 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015391 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015392 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015393 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15394 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015395
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015396no-tlsv13
15397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15398 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15399 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15400 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015401 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15402 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015403
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015404npn <protocols>
15405 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15406 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15407 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015408 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015409 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015410 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15411 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15412 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15413 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15414 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015415
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015416ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015417 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15418 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015419 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15420 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15421 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15422 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15423 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15424 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15425 configuration enabling it:
15426
15427 haproxy.cfg:
15428 frontend fe
15429 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15430
15431 haproxy.list:
15432 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15433
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015434 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15435 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15436 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15437 the OCSP certid to be built.
15438 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15439 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15440 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15441 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15442 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15443 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15444 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15445 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15446 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15447 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15448 short time after init.
15449 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15450 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015451 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15452 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15453 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015454 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15455
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015456 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15457 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15458 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15459 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15460 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15461 - a numerical update status
15462 - a textual update status
15463 - the number of update failures for the given response
15464 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015465 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015466 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15467 the concerned OCSP response update.
15468 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15469 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15470 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15471 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15472 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015473 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015474 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15475 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015476 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15477 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15478 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15479 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15480 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015481
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015482 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15483 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15484 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15485 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15486 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015487
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015488 Troubleshooting:
15489 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15490 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15491 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15492 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15493 section.
15494 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15495 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15496
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015497prefer-client-ciphers
15498 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15499 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15500 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015501 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15502 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15503 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015504
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015505proto <name>
15506 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15507 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15508 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015509 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15510 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15511
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015512 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15513 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15514 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015515
15516 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15517 a bind line :
15518
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015519 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015520 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15521 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15522
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015523 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015524 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015525 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015526 h2" on the bind line.
15527
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015528quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015529 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15530 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15531 to those used by TCP.
15532
15533 Default value: cubic
15534
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015535quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015536 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15537 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15538 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15539 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15540 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15541 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15542 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015543 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15544
15545 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15546 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015547
15548 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15549 information about QUIC retry.
15550
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015551shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015552 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15553 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15554 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15555 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15556 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15557 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15558 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15559 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15560 little bit.
15561
15562 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15563 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15564 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15565 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15566 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015567 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15568 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15569 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15570 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15571 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015572
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015573 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15574 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15575 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15576 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15577 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15578 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15579 listeners will not be the expected one.
15580
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015581sigalgs <sigalgs>
15582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15583 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15584 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15585 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15586 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15587 required.
15588
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015589ssl
15590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015591 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015592 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15593 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015594 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15595 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015596
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015597ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15598 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015599 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15600 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15601 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015602 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15603
15604ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015605 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15606 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15607 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15608 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015609
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015610strict-sni
15611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15612 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015613 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15614 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15615 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15616 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15617 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015618
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015619tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015620 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015621 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015622 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015623 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015624 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15625 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15626 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15627 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15628 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15629 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15630 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15631
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015632tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015633 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015634 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15635 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15636 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15637 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15638 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15639 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15640 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015641 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15642 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15643 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015644
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015645thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015646 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15647 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15648 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015649
15650 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15651 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015652 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15653 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15654 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15655 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15656 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15657 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15658 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15659 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015660
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015661 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15662 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015663
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015664 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15665
15666 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15667 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15668 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15669 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15670 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15671 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15672 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015673 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015674 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15675 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15676 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15677 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15678
15679 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15680 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15681 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15682 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15683 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15684 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015685
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015686 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15687 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15688 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15689 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15690 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15691 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15692 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15693 "option socket-stats" is used.
15694
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015695 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15696 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15697 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15698 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015699 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15700 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015701
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015702tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15703 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015704 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15705 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15706 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15707 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15708 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15709 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15710 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15711 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15712 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15713 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015714 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15715 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15716
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015717transparent
15718 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15719 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15720 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15721 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15722 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15723 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15724 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15725 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15726 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15727 so check for support with your vendor.
15728
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015729v4v6
15730 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15731 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15732 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15733 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015734 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015735
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015736v6only
15737 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15738 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15739 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015740 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15741 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015742
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015743uid <uid>
15744 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15745 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15746 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15747 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15748 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15749
15750user <user>
15751 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15752 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15753 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15754 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15755 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15756
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015757verify [none|optional|required]
15758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15759 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15760 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15761 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15762 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015763 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15764 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15765 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15766 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200157685.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015769------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015771The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15772which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15773arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15774settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15775after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15776Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15777address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015779 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015780 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015781
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015782Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15783keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015785The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015786
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015787addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015788 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015789 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15790 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15791 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15792 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15793 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015794
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015795agent-check
15796 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015797 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015798 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15799 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15800 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015801
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015802 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015803 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015804 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015805 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15806 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015807
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015808 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15809 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15810 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15811 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15812 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015813
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015814 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015815 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015816
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015817 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15818 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15819 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015820
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015821 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15822 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15823 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015824
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015825 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015826 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15827 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15828 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15829 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015830 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015831 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015832
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015833 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15834 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015835
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015836 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15837 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15838 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15839 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15840 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15841 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15842 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15843 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15844 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015845
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015846 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15847 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015848 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15849 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15850 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015851 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015852
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015853 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015854 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015855
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015856agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015857 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015858 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15859 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15860 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15861 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15862
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015863agent-inter <delay>
15864 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15865 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15866
15867 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15868 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15869 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15870 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15871 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15872 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15873 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15874 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15875 of backends use the same servers.
15876
15877 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15878
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015879agent-addr <addr>
15880 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15881
15882 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015883 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015884 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15885 hostname, it will be resolved.
15886
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015887agent-port <port>
15888 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15889
15890 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15891
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015892allow-0rtt
15893 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015894 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15895 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015896
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015897alpn <protocols>
15898 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15899 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15900 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015901 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015902 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15903 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15904 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15905 now obsolete NPN extension.
15906 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15907 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15908
15909 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15910
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015911 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015913backup
15914 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15915 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15916 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15917 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015918 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15919 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015920
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015921ca-file <cafile>
15922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15923 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015924 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15925 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015926 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015927
15928 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15929 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15930 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015932check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015933 This option enables health checks on a server:
15934 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15935 considered available.
15936 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15937 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15938 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15939 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15940 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015941 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15942 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015943 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15944 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15945 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15946 exchanges succeed.
15947
15948 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15949 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15950 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15951 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15952 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015953 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015954 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15955
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015956 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015957 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015958 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15959 not overridden.
15960
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015961 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15962 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15963
15964 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15965 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15966
15967 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15968 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15969 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15970 available.
15971
15972 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15973 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15974 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15975
15976 Example:
15977 # simple tcp check
15978 backend foo
15979 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15980 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15981 backend foo
15982 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15983 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15984 backend foo
15985 option tcp-check
15986 tcp-check connect
15987 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015988
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015989check-send-proxy
15990 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15991 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15992 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15993 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15994 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15995 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15996 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15997
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015998check-alpn <protocols>
15999 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
16000 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
16001 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
16002
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016003check-proto <name>
16004 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
16005 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
16006 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016007 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
16008 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16009
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016010 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16011 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16012 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016013
16014 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
16015 directive on a server line:
16016
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016017 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016018 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16019 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16020 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16021
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016022 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020016023 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
16024 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
16025
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016026check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016027 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010016028 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
16029 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020016030
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016031check-ssl
16032 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
16033 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
16034 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
16035 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016036 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016037 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
16038 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016039 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016040 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
16041 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016042
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016043check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016044 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016045 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
16046 for normal traffic.
16047
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016048ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
16050 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16051 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016052 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16053 information and recommendations see e.g.
16054 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16055 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16056 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016057
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016058ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16060 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
16061 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16062 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016063 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16064 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16065 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016067cookie <value>
16068 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16069 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16070 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16071 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16072 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16073 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16074 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16075
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016076crl-file <crlfile>
16077 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16078 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16079 to verify server's certificate.
16080
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016081crt <cert>
16082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16083 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16084 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16085 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16086 certificate request.
16087
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016088 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16089 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16090 option is set accordingly).
16091
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016092disabled
16093 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16094 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16095 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16096 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16097 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016098 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016099
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016100enabled
16101 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16102 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16103 default value.
16104 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16105 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016107error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016108 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16109 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16110 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016112 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016114fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016115 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16116 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16117 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16118
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016119force-sslv3
16120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16121 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016122 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016123 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016124
16125force-tlsv10
16126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016127 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016128 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016129
16130force-tlsv11
16131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016132 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016133 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016134
16135force-tlsv12
16136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016137 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016138 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016139
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016140force-tlsv13
16141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16142 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016143 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016145id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016146 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16147 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16148 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016149
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016150init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16151 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16152 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016153 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016154 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16155 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16156 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16157 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16158 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16159 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16160 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16161 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16162 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016163 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016164 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16165 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16166 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16167 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16168 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16169 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016170 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016171
16172 Example:
16173 defaults
16174 # never fail on address resolution
16175 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016177inter <delay>
16178fastinter <delay>
16179downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016180 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16181 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16182 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16183 between checks depending on the server state :
16184
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016185 Server state | Interval used
16186 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16187 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16188 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16189 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16190 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16191 or yet unchecked. |
16192 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16193 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16194 | "inter" otherwise.
16195 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016197 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16198 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16199 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16200 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016201 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16202 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16203 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16204 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16205 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016206
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016207log-proto <logproto>
16208 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16209 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16210 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16211 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016213maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016214 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16215 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016216 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16217 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016218 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16219 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16220 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16221 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16222
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016223 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16224 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16225 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16226 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16227 than 50 concurrent requests.
16228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016229maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016230 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16231 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16232 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16233 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016234 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16235 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16236 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16237 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16238 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16239 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16240 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016241
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016242max-reuse <count>
16243 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16244 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16245 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16246 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16247 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16248 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16249 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16250 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016252minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16254 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16255 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16256 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16257 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16258 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016259 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016260 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016261
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016262namespace <name>
16263 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16264 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16265 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16266 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16267
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016268no-agent-check
16269 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16270 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16271 default value.
16272 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16273 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16274
16275no-backup
16276 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16277 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16278 default value.
16279 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16280 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16281
16282no-check
16283 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16284 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16285 default value.
16286 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16287 "default-server" "check" setting.
16288
16289no-check-ssl
16290 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16291 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16292 default value.
16293 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16294 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16295
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016296no-send-proxy
16297 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16298 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16299 default value.
16300 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16301 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16302
16303no-send-proxy-v2
16304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16306 default value.
16307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16308 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16309
16310no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16311 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16312 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16313 default value.
16314 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16315 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16316
16317no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16318 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16319 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16320 default value.
16321 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16322 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16323
16324no-ssl
16325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16327 default value.
16328 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16329 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16330
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016331 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16332 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16333 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16334
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016335no-ssl-reuse
16336 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16337 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16338 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16339 and for paranoid users.
16340
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016341no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016342 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16343 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016344 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016345
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016346 Supported in default-server: No
16347
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016348no-tls-tickets
16349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16350 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16351 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016352 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16353 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016354 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16355 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16356 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016357 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016358
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016359no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016360 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016361 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16362 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016363 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16364 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016365 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016366
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016367 Supported in default-server: No
16368
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016369no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016370 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016371 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16372 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016373 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16374 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016375 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016376
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016377 Supported in default-server: No
16378
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016379no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016380 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016381 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16382 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016383 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16384 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016385 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016386
16387 Supported in default-server: No
16388
16389no-tlsv13
16390 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16391 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16392 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16393 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16394 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016395 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016396
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016397 Supported in default-server: No
16398
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016399no-verifyhost
16400 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16401 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16402 default value.
16403 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16404 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016405
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016406no-tfo
16407 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16408 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16409 default value.
16410 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16411 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16412
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016413non-stick
16414 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16415 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16416 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16417
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016418npn <protocols>
16419 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16420 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16421 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016422 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016423 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16424 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16425 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016427observe <mode>
16428 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16429 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16430 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16431 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16432 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16433 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016434 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016435
16436 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016438on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016439 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16440 Currently, four modes are available:
16441 - fastinter: force fastinter
16442 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16443 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16444 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16445 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16446
16447 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16448
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016449on-marked-down <action>
16450 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16451 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016452 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16453 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16454 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16455 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16456 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16457 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16458 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16459 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016460
16461 Actions are disabled by default
16462
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016463on-marked-up <action>
16464 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16465 Currently one action is available:
16466 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16467 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16468 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16469 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016470 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16471 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016472 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16473 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16474
16475 Actions are disabled by default
16476
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016477pool-low-conn <max>
16478 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16479 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16480 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16481 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16482 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16483 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16484 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16485 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16486 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16487 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016488 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16489 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16490 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16491 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016492
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016493pool-max-conn <max>
16494 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16495 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16496 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16497 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16498 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16499 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16500
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016501pool-purge-delay <delay>
16502 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016503 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016504 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016506port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016507 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016508 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16509 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16510 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16511 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16512 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016513
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016514proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016515 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16516 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16517 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016518 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16519 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16520
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016521 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16522 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16523 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016524
16525 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16526 a server line :
16527
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016528 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016529 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16530 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16531 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16532
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016533 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016534 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16535
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016536 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016538redir <prefix>
16539 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16540 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16541 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16542 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16543 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16544 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16545 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16546 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016547 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016549 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16550 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16551 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16552 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16553
16554 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016556rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016557 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16558 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16559 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16560
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016561resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16562 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16563 server.
16564
16565 Available options:
16566
16567 * allow-dup-ip
16568 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16569 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16570 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16571 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16572 For such case, simply enable this option.
16573 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16574
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016575 * ignore-weight
16576 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16577 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16578 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16579
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016580 * prevent-dup-ip
16581 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16582 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16583 same fqdn.
16584 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16585
16586 Example:
16587 backend b_myapp
16588 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16589 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16590 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16591
16592 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16593 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16594 it
16595 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16596 different address
16597
16598 Default value: not set
16599
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016600resolve-prefer <family>
16601 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16602 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16603 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16604 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16605
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016606 Default value: ipv6
16607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016608 Example:
16609
16610 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016611
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016612resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016613 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016614 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016615 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016616 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16617 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016618 configured network, another address is selected.
16619
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016620 Example:
16621
16622 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016623
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016624resolvers <id>
16625 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16626 hostname.
16627
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016628 Example:
16629
16630 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016631
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016632 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016633
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016634send-proxy
16635 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16636 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16637 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16638 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016639 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16640 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16641 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16642 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016643 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016644 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16645 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16646 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16647 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16648 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016649 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16650 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016651
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016652send-proxy-v2
16653 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16654 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16655 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16656 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016657 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16658 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16659 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16660 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016661
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016662proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016663 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16664 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16665
16666 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16667 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16668 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16669 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16670 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16671 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16672 connection is supported).
16673 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16674 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16675 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16676 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16677 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16678 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16679 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016680
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016681send-proxy-v2-ssl
16682 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16683 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16684 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16685 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16686 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16687 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16688 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016689 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16690 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016691
16692send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16693 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16694 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16695 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16696 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16697 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16698 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16699 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16700 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016701 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16702 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016703
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016704shard <shard>
16705 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16706 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16707 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16708 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16709 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16710 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16711 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16712
16713 Example :
16714
16715 peers mypeers
16716 shards 3
16717 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16718 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16719 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16720 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16721
16722
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016723slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016724 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16725 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16726 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16727 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16728 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16729 parameters :
16730
16731 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16732 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16733
16734 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16735 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16736 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16737 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16738
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016739 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016740 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16741 seen as failed.
16742
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016743sni <expression>
16744 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16745 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16746 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016747 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16748 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16749 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16750 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016751 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016752 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016753 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16754 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016755
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016756source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016757source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016758source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016759 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16760 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16761 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16762 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16763
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016764 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16765 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16766 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16767 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16768 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16769 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16770 server.
16771
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016772 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16773 specifying the source address without port(s).
16774
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016775ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016776 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16777 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16778 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16779 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16780 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16781 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016782 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16783 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016784
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016785ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16786 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16787 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16788 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16789
16790ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16791 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16792 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16793 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16794
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016795ssl-reuse
16796 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16797 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16798 default value.
16799 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16800 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16801
16802stick
16803 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16804 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16805 default value.
16806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16807 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016808
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016809socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016810 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016811 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16812 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16813
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016814tcp-ut <delay>
16815 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016816 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016817 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016818 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016819 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16820 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16821 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16822 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16823 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16824 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16825 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16826 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16827 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16828
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016829tfo
16830 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16831 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16832 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16833 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016834 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016835 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016836
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016837track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016838 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16839 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16840 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016841 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016842 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16843
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016844tls-tickets
16845 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16846 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16847 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016848 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16849 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16850 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016851 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016852 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016853
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016854verify [none|required]
16855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016856 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016857 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16858 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016859 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016860 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16861 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16862 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16863 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16864 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16865 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16866 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16867 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016868
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016869verifyhost <hostname>
16870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016871 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16872 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16873 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16874 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16875 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16876 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16877 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16878 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016880weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016881 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16882 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16883 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016884 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16885 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16886 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16887 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16888 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16889 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016890
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016891ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16892 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16893 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16894 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16895
16896 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16897 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16898 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16899 server ALPN contains it.
16900
16901 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16902 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16903 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16904 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16905
16906 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16907 favor of the ALPN extension.
16908
16909 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016911
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169125.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16913-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016914
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016915HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16916using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016917configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016918This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16919can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16920workload.
16921This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16922resolution at run time.
16923Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16924carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16925
16926
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169275.3.1. Global overview
16928----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016929
16930As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16931different steps of the process life:
16932
16933 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16934 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16935 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16936
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016937 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16938 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016939
16940A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16941 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16942 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16943 resolution to know this new IP.
16944
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016945When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016946HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016947SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16948from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016949will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016950will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016951
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016952A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016953 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016954 first valid response.
16955
16956 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16957 servers return an error.
16958
16959
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169605.3.2. The resolvers section
16961----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016962
16963This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016964HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16965contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016966
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016967At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16968no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16969default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16970failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16971
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016972When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16973uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16974is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16975answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16976
16977When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016978used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016979
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016980 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16981 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16982 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016983
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016984 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16985 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016986
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016987 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016988 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16989 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016990
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016991For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16992following scenarios are possible:
16993
16994 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16995 ignored
16996
16997 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16998 applied
16999
17000 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
17001 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
17002
17003 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
17004 retries the query with a new type
17005
17006 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
17007 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017008
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017009As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017010a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017011<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017012
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017013
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017014resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017015 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017016
17017A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
17018
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017019accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017020 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017021 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020017022 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
17023 by RFC 6891)
17024
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010017025 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
17026 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
17027 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
17028 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
17029 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
17030 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020017031
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017032nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
17033 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
17034 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
17035 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
17036 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
17037 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
17038 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
17039 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
17040 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
17041 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010017042 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
17043
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017044parse-resolv-conf
17045 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
17046 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
17047 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
17048
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017049hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017050 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17051 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17052 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17053 counteract the just received invalid status.
17054
17055 <status> : last name resolution status.
17056 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17057 status during the concluding period.
17058
17059 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17060 status during the concluding period.
17061
17062 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17063 valid status during the concluding period.
17064
17065 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17066 valid status during the concluding period.
17067
17068 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17069 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17070 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17071 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17072 dynamic resolution of servers.
17073
17074 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17075 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17076 applies to SRV records.
17077
17078 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17079 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17080 milliseconds by default.
17081
17082 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17083 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17084 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17085 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17086 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17087
17088 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17089 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17090 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17091 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17092
17093 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17094 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017095
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017096 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017097
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017098resolve_retries <nb>
17099 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17100 giving up.
17101 Default value: 3
17102
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017103 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17104 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17105 type.
17106
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017107timeout <event> <time>
17108 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17109 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17110 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017111 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17112 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017113 Default value: 1s
17114 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017115 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017116 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017117 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17118 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17119
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017120 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017121
17122 resolvers mydns
17123 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17124 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017125 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017126 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017127 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017128 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017129 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017130 hold other 30s
17131 hold refused 30s
17132 hold nx 30s
17133 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017134 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017135 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017136
17137
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200171386. Cache
17139---------
17140
17141HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17142(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17143RAM.
17144
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017145The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17146blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017147
17148If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17149independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17150when we try to allocate a new one.
17151
17152The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17153
17154It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17155"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17156for more details.
17157
17158When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17159replaced by "<CACHE>".
17160
17161
171626.1. Limitation
17163----------------
17164
17165The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17166
17167- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017168- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17169 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17170 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017171- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17172- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017173- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17174 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17175 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017176- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17177 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017178- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17179 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17180 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017181
17182- If the request is not a GET
17183- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17184- If the request contains an Authorization header
17185
17186
171876.2. Setup
17188-----------
17189
17190To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17191the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17192
17193
171946.2.1. Cache section
17195---------------------
17196
17197cache <name>
17198 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17199 size of cache is mandatory.
17200
17201total-max-size <megabytes>
17202 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17203 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17204
17205max-object-size <bytes>
17206 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17207 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17208 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17209
17210max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017211 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017212 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17213 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17214 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17215 default.
17216
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017217process-vary <on/off>
17218 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017219 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17220 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17221 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017222 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017223
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017224max-secondary-entries <number>
17225 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17226 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17227 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17228
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017229
172306.2.2. Proxy section
17231---------------------
17232
17233http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17234 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17235 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17236 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17237 after this one.
17238
17239http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17240 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17241 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17242 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17243 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17244
17245
17246Example:
17247
17248 backend bck1
17249 mode http
17250
17251 http-request cache-use foobar
17252 http-response cache-store foobar
17253 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17254
17255 cache foobar
17256 total-max-size 4
17257 max-age 240
17258
17259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200172607. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17261----------------------------------
17262
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017263HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17265The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17266these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17267but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17268data called patterns.
17269
17270
172717.1. ACL basics
17272---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017273
17274The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17275content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17276from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17277simple :
17278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017279 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017280 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17282 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17285adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017286
17287In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017290
17291This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17292Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17293and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017294an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17295conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17296as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17297are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017298
17299ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17300'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17301which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17302
17303There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17304performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17307specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17308this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017309methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17310ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017311
17312Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17313 - boolean
17314 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17315 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17316 - string
17317 - data block
17318
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017319Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17320converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17321would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17322The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17323which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17324
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017325Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17326keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17327fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17328which are summarized in the table below :
17329
17330 +---------------------+-----------------+
17331 | Sample or converter | Default |
17332 | output type | matching method |
17333 +---------------------+-----------------+
17334 | boolean | bool |
17335 +---------------------+-----------------+
17336 | integer | int |
17337 +---------------------+-----------------+
17338 | ip | ip |
17339 +---------------------+-----------------+
17340 | string | str |
17341 +---------------------+-----------------+
17342 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17343 +---------------------+-----------------+
17344
17345Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17346matching method, see below.
17347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17349 - boolean
17350 - integer or integer range
17351 - IP address / network
17352 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17353 - regular expression
17354 - hex block
17355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017356The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17357
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017358 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17359 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017361 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017362 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017363 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017364 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17367read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17368if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17369lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17370will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17371beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017372a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17374exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17375
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017376The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17377parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17378ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17379a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17380check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17381
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017382The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17383socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17384file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017386Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17387loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17388
17389 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17390
17391In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17392the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17393case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17394as well.
17395
17396The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17397sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17398do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17399methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17400is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017401obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17403default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17404that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17405string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17406
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017407The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17408By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17409string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17410resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017411server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017412waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017413flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17414function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017416There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17417sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17418be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017419
17420 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17421 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17423 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17424 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17425 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017426
17427 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17428 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017430
17431 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017432 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017433
17434 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017436
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017437 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017438 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17439
17440 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17441 binary or string samples.
17442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17444 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17447 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17448 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017450 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17451 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017453 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17454 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017456 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17457 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17460 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017461 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17464 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17465 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017466
17467For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17468request, it is possible to do :
17469
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017470 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017471
17472In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17473buffer, one would use the following acl :
17474
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017475 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017476
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017477On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17478possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17479
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017480 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17483criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17484method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017485to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17486usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17487converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17488method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17489matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17491the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017493If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017494the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17495For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17498 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17499 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17500 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017501
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017502
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017503The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17504types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17505combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17506brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17507default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017509 +-------------------------------------------------+
17510 | Input sample type |
17511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017512 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17514 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017516 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017518 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017520 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017522 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017524 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017526 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017528 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017530 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017532 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017534 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017536 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17538 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017540
17541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175427.1.1. Matching booleans
17543------------------------
17544
17545In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17546Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17547When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17548that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17549
17550Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17551return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17552"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175557.1.2. Matching integers
17556------------------------
17557
17558Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17559enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17560to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17561
17562Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17563matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17564lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017565
17566For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17567unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17568representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17569
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017570As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17571two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17572instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17573ranges and operators.
17574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017575For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017576operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17577Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17578of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017580Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017581
17582 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17583 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17584 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17585 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17586 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017588For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017589
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017590 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017591
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017592This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17593
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017594 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175977.1.3. Matching strings
17598-----------------------
17599
17600String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17601different forms :
17602
17603 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017604 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017605
17606 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017607 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608
17609 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17610 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17611
17612 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17613 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17614
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017615 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17616 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17617 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17618 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17619 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17620 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017622 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17623 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17624 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17625 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17626 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17627 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17628 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17629 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17630 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17631 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17632 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017633
17634String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17635exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17636characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17637string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17638to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017639before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017640
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017641Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17642(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17643Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17644
17645Example:
17646 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17647 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176507.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17651---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017652
17653Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17654they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17655possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17656passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17657the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017658the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17659match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017660
17661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176627.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17663-------------------------------------
17664
17665It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17666not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17667a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17668to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17669digits may be used upper or lower case.
17670
17671Example :
17672 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017673 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017674
17675
176767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17677---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017678
17679IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17680netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17681within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017682host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017683difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17684at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17685does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17686parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017687
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017688The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17689abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17690
17691 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17692 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17693 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17694 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17695 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17696 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17697 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17698 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17699
17700Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17701192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17702
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017703IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17704Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17705trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17706IPv6 patterns.
17707
17708HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17709following situations :
17710 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17711 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17712 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17713 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17714 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17715 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17716 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17717 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17718 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17719 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721
177227.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17723----------------------------------
17724
17725Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17726combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17727
17728 - AND (implicit)
17729 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17730 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017732A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017736Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17737indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17740"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17741requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17742is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17743
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017744 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017745 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17746 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17747 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748
17749To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17750and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17751
17752 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17753 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17754 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17755 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17756
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017757 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17759 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17760 use_backend www if host_www
17761
17762It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17763expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17764be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17765the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17766
17767 The following rule :
17768
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017769 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017770 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771
17772 Can also be written that way :
17773
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017774 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775
17776It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17777to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17778simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17779sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17780good use is the following :
17781
17782 With named ACLs :
17783
17784 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17785 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17786 monitor fail if site_dead
17787
17788 With anonymous ACLs :
17789
17790 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17791
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017792See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17793keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794
17795
177967.3. Fetching samples
17797---------------------
17798
17799Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17800against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17801sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17802ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17803of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17804available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17805
17806This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17807Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17808compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17809deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17810
17811The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17812matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17813method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17814indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17815
17816As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17817when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17818mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17819the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17820ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17821
17822Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17823multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17824when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017825incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17826are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17828all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17829
17830Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17831 - name
17832 - name(arg1)
17833 - name(arg1,arg2)
17834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017835
178367.3.1. Converters
17837-----------------
17838
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017839Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17840of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17841is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17842was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017843has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017844unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17845
17846These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17847sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17848the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017850
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017851A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17852support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17853supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17854(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17855bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017857The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017858
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001785951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17860 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17861 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17862 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17863 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17864 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17865
17866 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017867 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17868 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017869 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17870 frontend http-in
17871 bind *:8081
17872 default_backend servers
17873 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17874 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17875
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017876rfc7239_is_valid
17877 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17878 otherwise.
17879
17880 Example:
17881 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17882 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17883 # output: TRUE
17884 #input: "proto=custom"
17885 # output: FALSE
17886
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017887rfc7239_field(<field>)
17888 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17889
17890 Supported fields are:
17891 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17892 - host: http compliant host
17893 - for: RFC7239 node
17894 - by: RFC7239 node
17895
17896 More info here:
17897 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17898
17899 Example:
17900 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17901 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17902 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17903 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17904
17905 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17906 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17907 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17908 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17909
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017910rfc7239_n2nn
17911 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17912 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17913 - ipv4 address
17914 - ipv6 address
17915 - 'unknown'
17916 - '_obfs' identifier
17917
17918 Example:
17919 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17920 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17921 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017922 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17923 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17924 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17925 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17926 #input: "_name:_port"
17927 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017928
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017929rfc7239_n2np
17930 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17931 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17932 - unsigned integer
17933 - '_obfs' identifier
17934
17935 Example:
17936 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17937 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17938 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020017939 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017940 # output: 9999 (integer)
17941 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17942 # output: 9998 (integer)
17943 #input: "_name:_port"
17944 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017945
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017946add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017947 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017948 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017949 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17950 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017951 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017952 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17953 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17954 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17955 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017956 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017957 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017958
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017959add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17960 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17961 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17962 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17963 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17964 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17965 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17966 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17967 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17968 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17969 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17970 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17971 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17972 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17973 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17974 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17975 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17976 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017977 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17978 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017979
17980 Example:
17981 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17982 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17983 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17984 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17985
17986 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17987 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17988
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017989aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17990 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17991 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17992 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17993 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17994 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17995 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17996
17997 Example:
17998 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17999 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
18000
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018001and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018002 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018003 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018004 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18005 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18010 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018012 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018013
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018014b64dec
18015 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
18016 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018017 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
18018 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020018019
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018020base64
18021 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018022 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018023 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
18024 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020018025
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020018026be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
18027 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
18028 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
18029 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
18030 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
18031 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
18032
18033 Example:
18034 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
18035 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
18036 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
18037 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
18038
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020018039be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
18040 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
18041 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
18042 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
18043 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
18044 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
18045 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
18046
18047 Example:
18048 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
18049 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
18050 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18051 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18052
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018053bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018054 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018055 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018056 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018057 presence of a flag).
18058
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018059bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18060 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18061 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018062 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018063
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018064concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18065 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18066 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18067 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18068 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18069 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18070 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18071 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18072 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18073 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18074 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018075 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018076 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018077 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018078 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18079 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18080 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018081
18082 Example:
18083 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18084 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18085 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018086 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018087 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018088 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018090cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018091 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18092 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018093
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018094crc32([<avalanche>])
18095 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18096 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18097 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18098 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18099 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18100 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18101 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18102 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18103 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18104 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018105 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18106
18107crc32c([<avalanche>])
18108 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18109 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18110 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18111 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18112 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18113 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18114 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18115 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018116
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018117cut_crlf
18118 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18119 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18120 updated.
18121
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018122da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018123 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18124 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18125 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18126 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018127 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018128 configuration language.
18129
18130 Example:
18131 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018132 bind *:8881
18133 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018134 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018135
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018136debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18137 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18138 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18139 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18140 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18141 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18142 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18143 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18144 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18145 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18146 printable sample types.
18147
18148 Example:
18149 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018150
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018151digest(<algorithm>)
18152 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18153 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018155 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018156 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18157
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018158div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018159 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18160 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018161 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018162 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18163 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018164 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018165 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18166 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18167 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18168 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018169 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018170 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018171
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018172djb2([<avalanche>])
18173 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18174 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18175 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18176 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18177 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18178 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18179 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018180 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18181 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018182
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018183even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018184 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018185 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18186
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018187field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18188 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18189 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18190 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18191 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18192 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18193 fields.
18194
18195 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018196 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018197 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18198 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18199 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18200 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18201 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018202
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018203fix_is_valid
18204 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18205 Information eXchange):
18206
18207 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18208 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018209 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018210 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018211 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018212 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18213 checksum
18214
18215 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18216 the server can be parsed.
18217
18218 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18219 message, false if not.
18220
18221 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18222
18223 Example:
18224 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18225 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18226
18227fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18228 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18229 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18230 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18231 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018232 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018233 added.
18234
18235 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18236 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18237 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18238 fix_is_valid converter.
18239
18240 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18241
18242 Example:
18243 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18244 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18245 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18246 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18247 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018249hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018250 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018251 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018252 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018253 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018254
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018255hex2i
18256 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018257 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018258
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018259htonl
18260 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18261 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18262 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18263 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18264
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018265hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018266 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18267 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18268 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18269 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18270
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018271 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018272 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18273
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018274host_only
18275 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18276 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18277 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18278 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18279
18280 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18281
18282 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18283
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018284http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018285 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18286 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018287 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18288 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18289 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18290 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18291 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18292 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18293 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18294 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018296iif(<true>,<false>)
18297 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18298 string otherwise.
18299
18300 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018301 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018302
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018303in_table(<table>)
18304 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18305 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18306 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018307 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018308 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18309
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018310ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018311 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018312 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018313 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18314 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18315 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18316 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18317 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018318
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018319json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018320 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018321 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018322 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018323 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18324 of errors:
18325 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18326 bytes, ...)
18327 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18328 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18329
18330 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18331 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18332 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18333 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18334 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18335 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018336 - "ascii" : never fails;
18337 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18338 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018339 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018340 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018341 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18342 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18343
18344 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018345 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018346
18347 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018348 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018349 capture request header user-agent len 150
18350 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018351
18352 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18353 GET / HTTP/1.0
18354 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18355
18356 Output log:
18357 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18358
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018359json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18360 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18361 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18362 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18363 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18364
18365 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18366 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18367
18368 Example:
18369 # get a integer value from the request body
18370 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18371 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18372
18373 # get a key with '.' in the name
18374 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18375 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18376
18377 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18378 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18379
18380 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18381 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18382
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018383jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18384 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18385 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18386 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18387 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18388 json_path and output_type parameters.
18389
18390 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18391 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18392
18393jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18394 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18395 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18396 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18397 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18398 json_path and output_type parameters.
18399
18400 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18401 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18402
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018403jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18404 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18405 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018406 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018407 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18408 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18409 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18410 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018411
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018412 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018413 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018414 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18415 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018416
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018417 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18418 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18419 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18420 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18421 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18422 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018423 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018424 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18425
18426 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18427 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18428 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18429 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18430 contents.
18431
18432 The possible return values are the following :
18433
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018434 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18435 | ID | message |
18436 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018437 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018438 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018439 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018440 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018441 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18442 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18443 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018444 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018445
18446 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18447 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18448
18449 Example:
18450 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18451 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18452 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18453 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018454 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018455 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018457language(<value>[,<default>])
18458 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18459 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18460 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18461 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18462 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18463 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18464 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18465 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18466 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018467 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018468 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18469 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018471 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018473 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18474 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018476 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18477 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18478 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18479 use_backend spanish if es
18480 use_backend french if fr
18481 use_backend english if en
18482 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018483
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018484length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018485 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18486 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18487 type. The result is of type integer.
18488
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018489lower
18490 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18491 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18492 type. The result is of type string.
18493
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018494ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18495 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18496 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18497 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18498 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18499 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18500 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18501
18502 Example :
18503
18504 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018505 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018506 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18507
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018508ltrim(<chars>)
18509 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18510 representation of the input sample.
18511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018512map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18513map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18514map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18515 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18516 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18517 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18518 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18519 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18520 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18521 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18522 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018524 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18525 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18526 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018527
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018528 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018529 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018531 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18533 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018535 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018537 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18539 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18541 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18543 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018545 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18547 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18549 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18550 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18551 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18552 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018553
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018554 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18555 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18556 the corresponding match text.
18557
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018558 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18559 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18560 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18561 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18562 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018564 Example :
18565
18566 # this is a comment and is ignored
18567 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18568 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18569 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18570 | | | `---------- value
18571 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18572 | `---------------------------- key
18573 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18574
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018575mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018576 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18577 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018578 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018579 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018580 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018581 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18582 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18583 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18584 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018585 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018586 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018587
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018588mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018589 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18590 <packettype>.
18591 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18592 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18593 from.
18594 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18595 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18596 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18597
18598 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18599 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18600 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18601 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18602
18603 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18604 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18605 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18606 packets only):
18607 17: Session Expiry Interval
18608 33: Receive Maximum
18609 39: Maximum Packet Size
18610 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18611 25: Request Response Information
18612 23: Request Problem Information
18613 21: Authentication Method
18614 22: Authentication Data
18615 18: Will Delay Interval
18616 1: Payload Format Indicator
18617 2: Message Expiry Interval
18618 3: Content Type
18619 8: Response Topic
18620 9: Correlation Data
18621 Not supported yet:
18622 38: User Property
18623
18624 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18625 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18626 packets only):
18627 17: Session Expiry Interval
18628 33: Receive Maximum
18629 36: Maximum QoS
18630 37: Retain Available
18631 39: Maximum Packet Size
18632 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18633 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18634 31: Reason String
18635 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18636 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18637 42: Shared Subscription Available
18638 19: Server Keep Alive
18639 26: Response Information
18640 28: Server Reference
18641 21: Authentication Method
18642 22: Authentication Data
18643 Not supported yet:
18644 38: User Property
18645
18646 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18647 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18648 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18649 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18650
18651 Example:
18652
18653 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18654 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18655 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18656 if data_in_buffer
18657 # do the same as above
18658 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18659 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18660 if data_in_buffer
18661
18662mqtt_is_valid
18663 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18664
18665 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18666 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18667 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18668 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18669
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018670 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18671
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018672 Example:
18673
18674 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018675 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018676
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018677mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018678 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018679 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18680 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018681 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018682 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018683 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018684 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18685 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018690
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018691nbsrv
18692 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18693 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18694 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18695 map lookup.
18696
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018697neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018698 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18699 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18700 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18701 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018702
18703not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018704 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018705 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018706 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018707 absence of a flag).
18708
18709odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018710 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018711 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18712
18713or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018714 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018715 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018716 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18717 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018718 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018719 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18720 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18721 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18722 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018723 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018724 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018725
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018726param(<name>,[<delim>])
18727 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18728 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18729 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18730 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18731 a value of an empty string.
18732
18733 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18734 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18735 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18736 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18737
18738 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18739 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18740 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18741 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18742 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18743 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18744
18745 Example :
18746 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18747 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18748 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18749 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18750 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18751
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018752port_only
18753 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18754 returning its port.
18755 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18756 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18757 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18758
18759 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18760
18761 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18762
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018763protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18764 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18765 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18766 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18767 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18768 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18769 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18770 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18771 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18772 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18773 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18774 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18775
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018776regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018777 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18778 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18779 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18780 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18781 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18782 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18783 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18784 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18785 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018786 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18787 of characters with other ones.
18788
18789 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18790 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18791 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18792 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18793 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18794 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018795
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018796 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018797
18798 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18799 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18800 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018801 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018802
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018803 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18804 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18805
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018806 # capture groups and backreferences
18807 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018808 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018809 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18810
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018811capture-req(<id>)
18812 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18813 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18814
18815 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018816 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18817 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018818
18819capture-res(<id>)
18820 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18821 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18822
18823 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018824 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18825 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018826
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018827rtrim(<chars>)
18828 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18829 of the input sample.
18830
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018831sdbm([<avalanche>])
18832 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18833 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18834 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18835 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18836 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18837 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18838 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018839 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18840 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018841
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018842secure_memcmp(<var>)
18843 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18844 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18845 match.
18846
18847 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18848 performed in constant time.
18849
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018850 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018851 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18852
18853 Example :
18854
18855 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18856 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18857 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18858 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18859
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018860set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018861 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018862 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18863 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18864 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18865 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018866 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018867 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18868 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018869 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018870 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18871 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018872 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018873 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018874
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018875 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18876 possible conditions :
18877 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18878 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18879 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18880 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18881 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18882 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18883 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18884 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18885 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18886 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18887 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18888 called on the variable.
18889 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18890 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18891 configuration parsing.
18892 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18893 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18894 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18895 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18896 true by default.
18897
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018898sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018899 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018900 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18901
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018902sha2([<bits>])
18903 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18904 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18905
18906 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18907 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18908
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018909 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018910 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18911
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018912srv_queue
18913 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18914 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18915 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18916 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18917 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18918
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018919strcmp(<var>)
18920 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18921 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18922 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18923 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18924 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18925 shorter).
18926
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018927 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18928 strings in constant time.
18929
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018930 Example :
18931
18932 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18933 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18934 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18935
18936
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018937sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018938 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18939 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018940 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018941 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18942 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018943 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018946 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18948 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018949 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018950 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018951
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018952table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18956 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18957 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18958 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18959
18960
18961table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18962 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18963 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18964 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18965 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18966 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18967 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18968
18969table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18970 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18971 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018972 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018973 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18974 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18975
18976table_conn_cur(<table>)
18977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18980 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18981 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18982
18983table_conn_rate(<table>)
18984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18987 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18988 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18989
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018990table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18991 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18992 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18993 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18994 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18995 input sample in the designated table.
18996 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18997
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018998table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
19002 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
19003 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19004 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19005 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
19006 data-type).
19007 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19008
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019009table_gpt0(<table>)
19010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
19012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19013 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
19014 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
19015
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019016table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
19017 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19018 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19019 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
19020 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
19021 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
19022 between 0 and 99.
19023 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
19024 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19025 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19026 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
19027
19028table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
19029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
19030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19031 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
19032 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
19033 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
19034 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19035 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
19036 value 0.
19037 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
19038 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19039 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
19040
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019041table_gpc0(<table>)
19042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19044 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19045 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19046 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
19047
19048table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
19049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19052 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19053 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19054 sample fetch keyword.
19055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019056table_gpc1(<table>)
19057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19059 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19060 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19061 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19062
19063table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19067 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19068 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19069 sample fetch keyword.
19070
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019071table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019075 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19076 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19077
19078table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19081 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19082 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19083 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19084 keyword.
19085
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019086table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19090 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19091 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19092
19093table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19096 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19097 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19098 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19099 keyword.
19100
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019101table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019105 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19106 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19107
19108table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19111 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19112 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19113 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19114 keyword.
19115
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019116table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019117 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19118 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19119 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19120 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19121 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19122 updated.
19123 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19124
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019125table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19126 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19127 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019128 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019129 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19130 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19131 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19132 keyword.
19133
19134table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19135 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19136 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019137 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019138 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19139 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19140 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19141 keyword.
19142
19143table_server_id(<table>)
19144 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19145 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19146 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19147 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19148 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19149 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19150
19151table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19152 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19153 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019154 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019155 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19156 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19157 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19158 keyword.
19159
19160table_sess_rate(<table>)
19161 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19162 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19163 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19164 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19165 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19166 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19167 keyword.
19168
19169table_trackers(<table>)
19170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19172 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19173 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19174 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19175 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19176 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19177 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19178 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19179 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19180
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019181ub64dec
19182 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19183 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19184 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19185
19186 Example:
19187 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19188 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19189
19190ub64enc
19191 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19192
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019193upper
19194 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19195 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19196 type. The result is of type string.
19197
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019198url_dec([<in_form>])
19199 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19200 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19201 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19202 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19203 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19204 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019205
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019206url_enc([<enc_type>])
19207 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19208 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19209 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19210 optional argument is here for future changes.
19211
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019212ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019213 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019214 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19215 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19216 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019217 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19218 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19219 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19220 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019221 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019222 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19223 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019224
19225 Example:
19226 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19227 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19228
19229 message Point {
19230 int32 latitude = 1;
19231 int32 longitude = 2;
19232 }
19233
19234 message PPoint {
19235 Point point = 59;
19236 }
19237
19238 message Rectangle {
19239 // One corner of the rectangle.
19240 PPoint lo = 48;
19241 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19242 PPoint hi = 49;
19243 }
19244
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019245 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19246 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19247 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019248
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019249 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19250 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019251 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019252 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19253
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019254 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019255
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019256 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019257
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019258 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19259 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19260 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019261
19262 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19263 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19264 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19265
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019266 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19267 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19268 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019269
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019270
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019271unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019272 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19273 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19276 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19277 response),
19278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19280 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19281 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19282
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019283utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19284 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19285 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19286 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19287 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19288 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19289 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19290
19291 Example :
19292
19293 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019294 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019295 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19296
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019297word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19298 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19299 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19300 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019301 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19302 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19303 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019304 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19305 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19306
19307 Example :
19308 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019309 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019310 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19311 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19312 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19313 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019314 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019315 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019316
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019317wt6([<avalanche>])
19318 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19319 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19320 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19321 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19322 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19323 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19324 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019325 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19326 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019327
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019328xor(<value>)
19329 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019330 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019331 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019332 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019336 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019337 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19338 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019339 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019340 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019341
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019342xxh3([<seed>])
19343 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19344 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19345 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19346 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19347 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19348 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19349 considered as cryptographically secure.
19350
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019351xxh32([<seed>])
19352 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19353 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19354 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19355 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19356 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19357 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19358 as cryptographically secure.
19359
19360xxh64([<seed>])
19361 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19362 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19363 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19364 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19365 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19366 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19367 as cryptographically secure.
19368
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019369x509_v_err_str
19370 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19371 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19372 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19373
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019374 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19375 value as a string.
19376
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019377 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19378 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19379 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19380
19381 Example:
19382
19383 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19384
19385 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19386 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19387 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19388
19389 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19390 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19391 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019392
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019393 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19394
19395
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193967.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019397--------------------------------------------
19398
19399A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19400not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019401"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19403
19404always_false : boolean
19405 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19406 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19407
19408always_true : boolean
19409 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19410 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19411
19412avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019413 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19415 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19416 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19417 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19418 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19419 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19420 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19421 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19422 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19423 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19424 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19425 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19426 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019429 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19430 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19431 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19432 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019433 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19434
19435be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19436 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19437 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19438 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19439 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19440 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019441 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19442 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019443
19444 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19445 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19446 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019448be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19449 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19450 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19451 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019452 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19454 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019455
19456 Example :
19457 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19458 backend dynamic
19459 mode http
19460 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19461 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019462
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019463bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019464 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19465 of the string.
19466
19467bool(<bool>) : bool
19468 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19469 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019471connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19472 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019473 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019474 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19475 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019476
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019477 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019478 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019479 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19480
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019481 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19482 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019483
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019484 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019485 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019487 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019488 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019490 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019492 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19493 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019495 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019496
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019497cpu_calls : integer
19498 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19499 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19500 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19501 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19502 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19503 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19504
19505cpu_ns_avg : integer
19506 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19507 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19508 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19509 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19510 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19511 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19512 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19513 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19514 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19515 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19516 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19517
19518cpu_ns_tot : integer
19519 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19520 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19521 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19522 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19523 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19524 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19525 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19526 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19527 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19528 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19529 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19530 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19531 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19532
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019533date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019534 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019535
19536 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19537 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19538 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019539 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19540
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019541 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19542 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19543 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19544 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19545 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19546
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019547 Example :
19548
19549 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19550 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019551
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019552 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19553 # millisecond granularity
19554 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19555
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019556date_us : integer
19557 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19558 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19559 from the same timeval structure.
19560
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019561env(<name>) : string
19562 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19563 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19564 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19565 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19566 certain way.
19567
19568 Examples :
19569 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19570 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19571
19572 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019573 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19576 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019577 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19578 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019579 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19580 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019581 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019582 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19583 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019584
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019585fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19587 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19588 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019590fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19592 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19593 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19594 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19595 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19596 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19597 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19598 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019599
19600 Example :
19601 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19602 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19603 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19604 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19605 frontend mail
19606 bind :25
19607 mode tcp
19608 maxconn 100
19609 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19610 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19611 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19612 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019613
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019614hostname : string
19615 Returns the system hostname.
19616
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019617int(<integer>) : signed integer
19618 Returns a signed integer.
19619
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019620ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19621 Returns an ipv4.
19622
19623ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19624 Returns an ipv6.
19625
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019626last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019627 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19628 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19629 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19630 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19631 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19632 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19633 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19634 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19635 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19636 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19637 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19638 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19639
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019640last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019641 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19642 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19643 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19644 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19645 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19646 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19647 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19648 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19649 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19650 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19651 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19652 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19653
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019654lat_ns_avg : integer
19655 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19656 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19657 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19658 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19659 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19660 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19661 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19662 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19663 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019664 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19665 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19666 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19667 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19668 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19669 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019670
19671lat_ns_tot : integer
19672 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19673 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19674 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19675 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19676 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19677 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19678 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19679 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19680 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019681 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19682 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19683 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19684 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19685 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019686 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19687 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19688 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19689 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19690 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19691 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19692
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019693meth(<method>) : method
19694 Returns a method.
19695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19698 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19699 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019700 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19701 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19702 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019703
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019704prio_class : integer
19705 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19706 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19707 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19708
19709prio_offset : integer
19710 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19711 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19712 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19713 set-priority-offset".
19714
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019715proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019716 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19717 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019719queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019720 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19721 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19722 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019723 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19724 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19725 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19726 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19727 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19728
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019729quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019730 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19731 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19732 global option.
19733
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019734rand([<range>]) : integer
19735 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19736 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19737 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19738 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19739 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019741srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19743 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19744 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19745 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19746 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019747 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19748 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19749
19750srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19751 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19752 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19753 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19754 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19755 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19756 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19757 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19758
19759 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19760 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761
19762srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19763 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19764 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19765 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019766 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019767 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19768 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19769 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19770
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019771srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19773 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19774 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19775 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19776 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19777 fetch methods.
19778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19780 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19781 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019782 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019783 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19784 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019785 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019786 overloading servers).
19787
19788 Example :
19789 # Redirect to a separate back
19790 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19791 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19792 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19793
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019794srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019795 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19796 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19797 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19798
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019799srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019800 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19801 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19802 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19803
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019804srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019805 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19806 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19807 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19808
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019809stopping : boolean
19810 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19811 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19812 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19813
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019814str(<string>) : string
19815 Returns a string.
19816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019817table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19818 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19819 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19820
19821table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19822 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19823 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19824 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19825
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019826thread : integer
19827 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19828 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19829 and debugging purposes.
19830
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019831uuid([<version>]) : string
19832 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19833 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19834 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19835
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019836var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019837 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019838 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19839 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19840 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019841 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019842 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19843 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019844 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019848 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019849
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198507.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019851----------------------------------
19852
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019853The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19855methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19856sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19857TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019858the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19859counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019860"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019861used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19862counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19863"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19864An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19865currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19866the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019867
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019868bc_dst : ip
19869 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19870 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19871 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19872 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19873
19874bc_dst_port : integer
19875 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019876 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019877
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019878bc_err : integer
19879 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19880 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19881 and their corresponding error message.
19882
19883bc_err_str : string
19884 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19885 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19886 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19887 corresponding error message.
19888
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010019889bc_glitches : integer
19890 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the backend connection.
19891 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
19892 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving server that may cause trouble in
19893 the infrastructure (e.g. cause connections to be aborted early, inducing
19894 frequent TLS renegotiations). These may also be caused by too large responses
19895 that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining HTTP 502 errors. Ideally
19896 this number should remain zero, though it's generally fine if it remains very
19897 low compared to the total number of requests. These values should normally
19898 not be considered as alarming (especially small ones), though a sudden jump
19899 may indicate an anomaly somewhere. Not all protocol multiplexers measure this
19900 metric and the only way to get more details about the events is to enable
19901 traces to capture all exchanges.
19902
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019903bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019904 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19905 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19906 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19907
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019908bc_src : ip
19909 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019910 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019911 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19912 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19913
19914bc_src_port : integer
19915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019916 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019918be_id : integer
19919 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019920 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19921 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019923be_name : string
19924 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019925 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19926 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019927
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019928bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19929 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19930 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19931 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19932 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19933 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19934 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19935
19936bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19937 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19938 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19939 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19940 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19941 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19942 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19943
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019944be_server_timeout : integer
19945 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19946 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19947 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19948
19949be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19950 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19951 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19952 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19953
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019954cur_server_timeout : integer
19955 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19956 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19957 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19958
19959cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19960 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19961 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19962 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019964dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019965 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19966 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19967 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19968 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19969 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19970 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19971 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19972 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19973 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19974 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19975 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976
19977dst_conn : integer
19978 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19979 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19980 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19981 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19982 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19983 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19984 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19985 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019986
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019987dst_is_local : boolean
19988 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19989 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19990 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19991 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019992 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019993 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19994 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19995 it only once per connection.
19996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019997dst_port : integer
19998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19999 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020000 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
20001 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
20002 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
20003 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020004
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020005fc_dst : ip
20006 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
20007 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
20008 for details.
20009
20010fc_dst_is_local : boolean
20011 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
20012 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
20013 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
20014
20015fc_dst_port : integer
20016 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
20017 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
20018 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
20019
20020fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020021 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
20022 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
20023 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010020024 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020025 error codes and their corresponding error message.
20026
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010020027fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050020028 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020029 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010020030 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020031 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
20032
20033 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20034 | ID | message |
20035 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20036 | 0 | "Success" |
20037 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
20038 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
20039 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
20040 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
20041 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
20042 | 6 | "General socket error" |
20043 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
20044 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
20045 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
20046 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
20047 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20048 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20049 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
20050 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
20051 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
20052 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
20053 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
20054 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20055 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
20056 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
20057 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
20058 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
20059 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
20060 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
20061 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
20062 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
20063 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
20064 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20065 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20066 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20067 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20068 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20069 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20070 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20071 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20072 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20073 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20074 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20075 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20076 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20077 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20078 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020079 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020080 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20081
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020082fc_fackets : integer
20083 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20084 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20085 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20086 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20087
Willy Tarreau0d953302024-01-17 18:00:21 +010020088fc_glitches : integer
20089 Returns the number of protocol glitches counted on the frontend connection.
20090 These generally cover protocol violations as well as small anomalies that
20091 generally indicate a bogus or misbehaving client that may cause trouble in
20092 the infrastructure, such as excess of errors in the logs, or many connections
20093 being aborted early, inducing frequent TLS renegotiations. These may also be
20094 caused by too large requests that cannot fit into a single buffer, explaining
20095 HTTP 400 errors. Ideally this number should remain zero, though it may be
20096 possible that some browsers playing with the protocol boundaries trigger it
20097 once in a while. These values should normally not be considered as alarming
20098 (especially small ones), though a sudden jump may indicate an anomaly
20099 somewhere. Large values (i.e. hundreds to thousands per connection, or as
20100 many as the requests) may indicate a purposely built client that is trying to
20101 fingerprint or attack the protocol stack. Not all protocol multiplexers
20102 measure this metric, and the only way to get more details about the events is
20103 to enable traces to capture all exchanges.
20104
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020105fc_http_major : integer
20106 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20107 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20108 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20109
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020110fc_lost : integer
20111 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20112 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20113 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20114 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20115
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020116fc_pp_authority : string
20117 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20118 if any.
20119
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020120fc_pp_unique_id : string
20121 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20122 if any.
20123
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020124fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20125 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20126 header.
20127
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020128fc_reordering : integer
20129 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20130 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20131 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20132 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20133
20134fc_retrans : integer
20135 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20136 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20137 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20138 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20139
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020140fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20141 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20142 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20143 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20144 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20145 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20146 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20147
20148fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20149 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20150 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20151 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20152 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20153 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20154 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20155
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020156fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020157 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20158 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20159 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20160 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20161
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020162fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020163 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20164 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20165 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020166
20167fc_src_is_local : boolean
20168 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20169 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20170 "src_is_local" for details.
20171
20172fc_src_port : integer
20173
20174 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20175 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20176 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20177
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020178
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020179fc_unacked : integer
20180 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20181 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20182 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20183 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020184
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020185fe_defbe : string
20186 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20187 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020189fe_id : integer
20190 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020191 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020192 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20193
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020194fe_name : string
20195 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20196 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20197 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20198
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020199fe_client_timeout : integer
20200 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20201 current frontend.
20202
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020203sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020204sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20205sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20206sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020207 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20208 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20209 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020211sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020212sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20213sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20214sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020215 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20216 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20217 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20218
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020219sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20220 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20221 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20222 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20223 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20224 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20225 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20226 will always return zero.
20227 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20228 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20229
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020230sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020231sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20232sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20233sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020234 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20235 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020236 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20237 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20238 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020239
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020240 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020241 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20242 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020243 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20244 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20245 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020246 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20247 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20248
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020249sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20250sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20251sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20252sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20253 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20254 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20255 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20256 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20257 when a first ACL was verified.
20258
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020259sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020260sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20261sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20262sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020263 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020264 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020266sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020267sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20268sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20269sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020270 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20271 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20272 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20273
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020274sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020275sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20276sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20277sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020278 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20279 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20280 See also src_conn_rate.
20281
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020282sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20283 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20284 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20285 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20286 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20287 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20288 index, zero is returned.
20289 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20290 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20291
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020292sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020293sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20294sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20295sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020296 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020297 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020298
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020299sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20300sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20301sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20302sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20303 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20304 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20305
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020306sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20307 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20308 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20309 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20310 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20311 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20312 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20313 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20314
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020315sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20316sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20317sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20318sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20319 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20320 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20321
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020322sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20323 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20324 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20325 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20326 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20327 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20328 between 0 and 2.
20329 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20330 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20331 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20332 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20333 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20334
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020335sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020336sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20337sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20338sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020339 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20340 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20341 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020342 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20343 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20344 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020345
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020346sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20347sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20348sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20349sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20350 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20351 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20352 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20353 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20354 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20355 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20356
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020357sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020358sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20359sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20360sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020361 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020362 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20363 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020365sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020366sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20367sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20368sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020369 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20370 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20371 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20372 src_http_err_rate.
20373
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020374sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20375sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20376sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20377sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20378 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20379 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20380 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20381
20382sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20383sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20384sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20385sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20386 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20387 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20388 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20389 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20390
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020391sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020392sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20393sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20394sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020395 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020396 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20397 src_http_req_cnt.
20398
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020399sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020400sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20401sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20402sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020403 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20404 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20405 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20406 src_http_req_rate.
20407
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020408sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20409 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20410 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20411 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20412 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20413 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20414 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20415 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20416 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20417 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020419sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020420sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20421sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20422sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020423 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020424 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20425 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20426 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20427 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020428
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020429 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020430 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20431 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020432 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20433
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020434sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20435sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20436sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20437sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20438 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20439 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20440 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20441 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20442 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020444sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020445sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20446sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20447sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020448 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20449 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20450 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020452sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020453sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20454sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20455sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020456 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20457 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20458 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020459
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020460sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020461sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20462sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20463sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020464 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020465 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20466 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20467 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020468 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020469 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020471sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020472sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20473sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20474sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020475 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20476 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20477 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20478 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20479 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020480 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020482sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020483sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20484sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20485sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020486 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20487 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20488 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020490sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020491sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20492sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20493sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020494 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20495 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020496 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020497 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20498 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020499 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20500 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20501 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503so_id : integer
20504 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20505 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20506 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020507
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020508so_name : string
20509 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20510 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20511 strings instead of integers.
20512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020513src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020514 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20515 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20516 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20517 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20518 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20519 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20520 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20521 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20522 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20523 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20524 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20525 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20526 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20527 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20528 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020529
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020530 Example:
20531 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20532 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020534src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20535 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20536 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20537 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020538 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020540src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20541 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20542 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020543 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020544 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020545
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020546src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20547 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20548 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20549 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20550 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20551 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20552 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20553 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20554 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020556src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20557 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20558 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20559 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20560 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20561 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20562 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020563
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020564 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020565 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20566 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20567 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20568 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020569 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020570 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20571 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20572
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020573src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20574 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20575 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20576 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20577 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20578 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20579 was verified.
20580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020581src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020582 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020583 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020584 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020585 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020587src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020588 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020589 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20590 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020591 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020593src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20594 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20595 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20596 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020597 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020598
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020599src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20600 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20601 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20602 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20603 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20604 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20605 is returned.
20606 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20607 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20608 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020610src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020611 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020612 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020613 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020614 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020615
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020616src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20617 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20618 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20619 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20620 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20621
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020622src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20624 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20625 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20626 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20627 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20628 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20629
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020630src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20631 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20632 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20633 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20634 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20635
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020636src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20637 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20638 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20639 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20640 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20641 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20642 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20643 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20644 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20645 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20646 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020648src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020649 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020650 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020651 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20652 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020653 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20654 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20655 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020656
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020657src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20658 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20659 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20660 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20661 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20662 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20663 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20664 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020666src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020667 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020668 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020669 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020670 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020671 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020673src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20674 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20675 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20676 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20677 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020678 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020679
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020680src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20681 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20682 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020683 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020684 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20685 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20686
20687src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20688 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20689 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20690 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20691 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20692 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20693 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020695src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020696 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020697 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20698 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020699 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020701src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20702 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20703 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20704 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020705 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020706 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020707
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020708src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20709 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20710 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20711 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20712 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20713 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20714 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20715 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20716 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020718src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20719 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20720 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20721 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020722 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020723 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20724 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020725
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020726 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020727 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020728 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020729 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020730
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020731src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20732 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20733 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20734 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20735 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20736 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20737 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20738
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020739src_is_local : boolean
20740 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20741 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20742 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20743 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020744 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020745 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20746 once per connection.
20747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020748src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020749 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20750 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20751 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20752 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20753 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020755src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020756 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20757 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20758 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20759 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20760 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020762src_port : integer
20763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020764 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20765 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20766 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20767 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020769src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020770 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020771 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20772 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20773 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020774 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020776src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20777 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20778 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20779 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20780 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020781 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020783src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20784 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20785 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20786 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20787 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20788 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20789 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20790 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20791 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020792
20793 Example :
20794 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20795 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20796 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20797 listen ssh
20798 bind :22
20799 mode tcp
20800 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020801 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020802 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020803 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020805srv_id : integer
20806 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20807 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020808 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020809
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020810srv_name : string
20811 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20812 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020813 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208157.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020816----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020817
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020818The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020819closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20820when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20821usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020822future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020823
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002082451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20825 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20826 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20827 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20828 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20829 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20830
20831 Example :
20832 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20833 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20834 # the request.
20835 frontend http-in
20836 bind *:8081
20837 default_backend servers
20838 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20839 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20840
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020841ssl_bc : boolean
20842 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20843 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020844 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020845 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020846
20847ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20848 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020849 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20850 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020851
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020852ssl_bc_alpn : string
20853 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20854 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020855 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020856 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20857 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20858 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20859 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20860 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020861 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20862 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020863
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020864ssl_bc_cipher : string
20865 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020866 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20867 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020868
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020869ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20870 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20871 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20872 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020873 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020874
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020875ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020876 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020877 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20878 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20879 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20880 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020881 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20882 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20883 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20884
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020885ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020886 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020887 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20888 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20889 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020890
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020891ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20892 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20893 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020894 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20895 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020896
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020897ssl_bc_npn : string
20898 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20899 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020900 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020901 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20902 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20903 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20904 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020905 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20906 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020907
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020908ssl_bc_protocol : string
20909 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020910 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20911 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020912
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020913ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020914 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020915 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020916 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20917 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020918
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020919ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20920 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20921 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20922 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020923 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020924
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020925ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20926 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20927 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020928 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20929 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020930
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020931ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20932 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20933 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20934 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020935 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020936
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020937ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20938 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020939 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20940 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020942ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20943 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20944 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20945 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20946 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20947 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020949ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20950 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20951 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20952 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20953 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020954
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020955ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020956 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20957 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20958 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020959 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020960 does not support resumed sessions.
20961
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020962ssl_c_der : binary
20963 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20964 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20965 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020967ssl_c_err : integer
20968 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20969 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20970 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20971 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20972 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020973
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020974ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020975 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20976 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20977 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20978 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20979 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20980 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20981 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20982 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020983 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20984 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20985 LDAP v3.
20986 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20987 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020989ssl_c_key_alg : string
20990 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20991 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20992 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020994ssl_c_notafter : string
20995 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20996 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20997 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020999ssl_c_notbefore : string
21000 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
21001 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21002 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021003
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070021004ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21005 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
21006 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
21007 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
21008 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
21009 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
21010 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
21011 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
21012 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
21013 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
21014 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
21015 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
21016 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21017
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021018ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021019 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21020 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21021 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21022 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21023 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21024 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21025 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21026 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021027 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21028 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21029 LDAP v3.
21030 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21031 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010021032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021033ssl_c_serial : binary
21034 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
21035 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21036 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021038ssl_c_sha1 : binary
21039 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
21040 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
21041 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021042 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
21043 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
21044
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021045 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020021046 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021048ssl_c_sig_alg : string
21049 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21050 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21051 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021053ssl_c_used : boolean
21054 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
21055 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021057ssl_c_verify : integer
21058 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
21059 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
21060 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
21061 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021063ssl_c_version : integer
21064 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
21065 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021066
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010021067ssl_f_der : binary
21068 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
21069 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21070 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21071
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021072ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021073 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21074 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21075 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21076 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021077 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021078 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21079 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21080 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021081 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21082 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21083 LDAP v3.
21084 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21085 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021087ssl_f_key_alg : string
21088 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21089 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21090 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021092ssl_f_notafter : string
21093 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21094 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21095 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021097ssl_f_notbefore : string
21098 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21099 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21100 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021101
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021102ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021103 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21104 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21105 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21106 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21107 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21108 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21109 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21110 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021111 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21112 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21113 LDAP v3.
21114 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21115 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021117ssl_f_serial : binary
21118 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21119 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21120 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021121
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021122ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21123 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21124 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21125 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021127ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21128 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21129 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21130 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021132ssl_f_version : integer
21133 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21134 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21135
21136ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021137 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21138 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21139 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021141 Example :
21142 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21143 listen http-https
21144 bind :80
21145 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21146 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21147
21148ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21151
21152ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021153 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021154 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021155 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021156 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21157 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21158 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21159 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21160 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21161 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021163ssl_fc_cipher : string
21164 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21165 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021166
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021167ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21168 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21169 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021170 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021171 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21172 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21173 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021174
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021175 Example:
21176 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21177 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21178 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21179 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21180 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21181 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21182 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21183 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21184 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21185
21186ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021187 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021188 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021189 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21190 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021191 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21192 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021193
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021194ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021195 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021196 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021197 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021198 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21199 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21200 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21201 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21202 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21203 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021204
21205ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021206 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021207 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21208 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021209
21210ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21211 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21212 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021213 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021214
21215 Example:
21216 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21217 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21218 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21219 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21220 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21221 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21222 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21223 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21224 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21225
21226ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21227 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21228 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021229 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021230 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21231 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21232 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21233
21234 Example:
21235 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21236 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21237 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21238 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21239 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21240 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21241 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21242 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21243 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21244
21245ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21246 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21247 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021248 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021249 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21250 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21251 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21252
21253 Example:
21254 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21255 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21256 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21257 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21258 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21259 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21260 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21261 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21262 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021263
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021264ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21265 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21266 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21267 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21268
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021269ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21270 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21271 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21272 transport layer.
21273 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21274 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21275 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21276 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21277
21278ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21279 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21280 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21281 transport layer.
21282 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21283 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21284 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21285 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21286
21287ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21288 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21289 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21290 transport layer.
21291 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21292 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21293 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21294 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21295
21296ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21297 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21298 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21299 transport layer.
21300 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21301 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21302 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21303 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21304
21305ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21306 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21307 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21308 transport layer.
21309 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21310 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21311 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21312 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21313
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021314ssl_fc_err : integer
21315 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21316 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21317 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21318 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21319 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21320 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21321 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21322 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21323 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21324 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21325 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21326 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21327 codes.
21328
21329ssl_fc_err_str : string
21330 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21331 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21332 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21333 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21334 also "ssl_fc_err".
21335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021336ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021337 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21338 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021339 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21340 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21341 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21342 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021343
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021344ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21345 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21346 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21347 wait until the handshake happened.
21348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021349ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21350 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021351 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21352 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021353 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021354 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021355
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021356ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021357 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021358 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21359 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021361ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021362 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021363 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021364 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21365 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21366 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21367 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21368 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21369 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021371ssl_fc_protocol : string
21372 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21373 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021374
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021375ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21376 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21377 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021378 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21379 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021380
21381 Example:
21382 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21383 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21384 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21385 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21386 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21387 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21388 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21389 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21390 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21391
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021392ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021394 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021395 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021396
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021397ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21398 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21399 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21400 transport layer.
21401 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21402 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21403 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21404 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21405
21406ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21407 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21408 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21409 transport layer.
21410 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21411 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21412 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21413 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21414
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021415ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21416 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21417 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21418 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021420ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21421 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21422 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21423 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21424 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021425
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021426ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21427 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21428 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21429 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21430 BoringSSL.
21431
21432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021433ssl_fc_sni : string
21434 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21435 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021436 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021437 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21438 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21439
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021440 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021441 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021442 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021443 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021444 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021445
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021446 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21447 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21448 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21449 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21450 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21451 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21452 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21453 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21454 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021456 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021457 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21458 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021460ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021463
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021464ssl_s_der : binary
21465 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21466 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21467 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21468
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021469ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21470 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21471 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21472 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021473 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021474 does not support resumed sessions.
21475
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021476ssl_s_key_alg : string
21477 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21478 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21479 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21480
21481ssl_s_notafter : string
21482 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21483 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21484 transport layer.
21485
21486ssl_s_notbefore : string
21487 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21488 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21489 transport layer.
21490
21491ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21492 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21493 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21494 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21495 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21496 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21497 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021498 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21499 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021500 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21501 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21502 LDAP v3.
21503 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21504 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21505
21506ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21507 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21508 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21509 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21510 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21511 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21512 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021513 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21514 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021515 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21516 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21517 LDAP v3.
21518 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21519 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21520
21521ssl_s_serial : binary
21522 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21523 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21524 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21525
21526ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21527 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21528 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21529 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21530
21531ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21532 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21533 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21534 layer.
21535
21536ssl_s_version : integer
21537 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21538 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021539
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200215407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021541------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021543Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21544sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21545only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21546For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21547be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21548can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21549sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21550for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21551content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021552
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021553Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21554 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021555 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021556 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21557 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21558 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21559 sample expression). So be careful.
21560
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021561distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21562 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21563 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21564 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21565 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21566 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21567 list of supported tokens.
21568
21569distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21570 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21571 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21572 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21573 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21574 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21575 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21576 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21577 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21578 supported tokens.
21579
21580 Example :
21581 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21582 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21583 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21584 # send large files to the big farm
21585 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021587payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021588 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021589 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21590 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021592payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21593 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021594 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021595 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021597req.len : integer
21598req_len : integer (deprecated)
21599 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21600 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21601 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21602 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21603 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021604 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021605 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21606 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021608req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21609 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021610 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21611 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21612 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21613 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021614
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021615 ACL derivatives :
21616 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021618req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21619 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21620 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21621 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21622 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021623
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021624 ACL derivatives :
21625 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021627 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021629req.proto_http : boolean
21630req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21631 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21632 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21633 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21634 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21635 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21636 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21637 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021639 Example:
21640 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21641 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21642 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021643 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021645req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21646rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21647 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21648 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21649 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21650 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21651 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21652 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21653 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021655 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21656 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21657 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21658 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21659 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21660 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021662 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021663 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021665 Example :
21666 listen tse-farm
21667 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21668 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21669 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21670 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21671 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21672 persist rdp-cookie
21673 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21674 # This is only useful makes sense if
21675 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21676 stick-table type string size 204800
21677 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21678 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21679 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021681 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021682 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021684req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21685rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21686 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21687 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21688 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21689 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021691 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021692 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021693
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021694req.ssl_alpn : string
21695 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21696 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21697 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21698 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21699 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21700 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021701 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021702
21703 Examples :
21704 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21705 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021706 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021707 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021708 default_backend bk_default
21709
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021710req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21711 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21712 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021713 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21714 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21715 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21716 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21717 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021719req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21720req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21721 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21722 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21723 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21724 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21725 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21726 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21727 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021729req.ssl_sni : string
21730req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21731 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21732 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21733 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21734 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21735 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021736 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21737 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21738 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21739 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21740 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21741 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21742 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21743 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21744 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021746 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021747 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021749 Examples :
21750 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21751 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021752 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021753 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021754 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021755
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021756req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21757 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21758 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21759 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21760 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21761 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21762 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21763 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21764 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21765 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021767req.ssl_ver : integer
21768req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21769 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21770 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21771 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21772 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21773 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21774 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21775 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021776 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021777 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021779 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021780 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021781
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021782res.len : integer
21783 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21784 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21785 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21786 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21787 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021788 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021789 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021790 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021792res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21793 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021794 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021795 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021796 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021797 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021799res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21800 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21801 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21802 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021803 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21804 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021806 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021807
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021808res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21809rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21810 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21811 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21812 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21813 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21814 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21815 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21816 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021818wait_end : boolean
21819 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21820 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021821 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021822 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21823 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021824 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021825 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21826 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021828 Examples :
21829 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21830 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21831 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021833 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21834 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21835 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21836 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21837 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21838 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21839 tcp-request content reject
21840
21841
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200218427.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021843--------------------------------------
21844
21845It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21846This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21847data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21848its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21849HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21850content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21851to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21852more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21853response are indexed.
21854
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021855Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21856 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21857 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21858 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21859 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21860 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21861 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021863base : string
21864 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21865 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21866 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21867 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21868 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21869 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21870 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21871 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21872
21873 ACL derivatives :
21874 base : exact string match
21875 base_beg : prefix match
21876 base_dir : subdir match
21877 base_dom : domain match
21878 base_end : suffix match
21879 base_len : length match
21880 base_reg : regex match
21881 base_sub : substring match
21882
21883base32 : integer
21884 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21885 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21886 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021887 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21888 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21889 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021890
21891base32+src : binary
21892 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21893 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21894 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21895 per-URL counters.
21896
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021897baseq : string
21898 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21899 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21900 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21901 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21902
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021903capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21904 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21905 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21906 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21907
21908capture.req.method : string
21909 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21910 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21911 because it's allocated.
21912
21913capture.req.uri : string
21914 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21915 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21916 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21917 allocated.
21918
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021919capture.req.ver : string
21920 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21921 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21922 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21923
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021924capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21925 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21926 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21927 The first entry is an index of 0.
21928 See also: "capture response header"
21929
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021930capture.res.ver : string
21931 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21932 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21933 persistent flag.
21934
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021935req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021936 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21937 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21938 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021939
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021940req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021941 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21942 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21943 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21944 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021945 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
21946 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
21947 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
21948 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
21949 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
21950 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021951
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021952req.body_len : integer
21953 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21954 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021955 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21956 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021957
21958req.body_size : integer
21959 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021960 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21961 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021963req.cook([<name>]) : string
21964cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21965 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21966 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21967 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21968 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21969 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21970 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21971 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21972 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21973
21974 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021975 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21976 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21977 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21978 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21979 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21980 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21981 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21982 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021984req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21985cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21986 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21987 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021989req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21990cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21991 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21992 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21993 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21994 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021996cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21997 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21998 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21999 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
22000 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022001 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022002 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
22003 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
22004 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
22005 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022007hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22008 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
22009 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
22010 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
22011 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022012 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022014req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022015 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
22016 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
22017 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
22018 with headers such as User-Agent.
22019
22020 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22021 found.
22022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022023 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22024 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22025 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022026 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022028req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22029 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22030 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022031 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
22032 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022034req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022035 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
22036 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
22037 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
22038 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
22039 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
22040 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
22041 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
22042
22043 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
22044 found.
22045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022046 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
22047 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
22048 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022049 with -1 being the last one.
22050
22051 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
22052 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022054 ACL derivatives :
22055 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22056 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22057 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22058 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22059 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22060 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22061 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22062 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
22063
22064req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22065hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
22066 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
22067 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022068 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
22069 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
22070 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
22071
22072 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
22073 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
22074 which contain more than one of certain headers.
22075
22076 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022077
22078req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22079hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
22080 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
22081 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22082 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022083 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22084 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22085 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22086 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22087 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022088
22089 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22090
22091 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022092
22093req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22094hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22095 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22096 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22097 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022098
22099 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22100
22101 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022102
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022103req.hdrs : string
22104 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22105 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22106 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22107 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22108
22109req.hdrs_bin : binary
22110 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22111 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22112 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22113 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22114 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22115 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22116
22117 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022118
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022119 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22120 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022122http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22123 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22124 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22125 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22126 basic auth is supported.
22127
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022128http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22129 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22130 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22131 performed on the data sent by the client.
22132 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22133 Authorization one.
22134
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022135http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22136 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22137 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22138 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22139 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022140 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22141 basic auth is supported.
22142
22143 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022144 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22145 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22146 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22147 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022148
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022149http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022150 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22151 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22152 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022153
22154http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022155 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22156 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22157 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022158
22159http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022160 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22161 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22162 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022164http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022165 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22166 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022167 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22168 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022170method : integer + string
22171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22172 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22173 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22174 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22175 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22176 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22177 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022179 ACL derivatives :
22180 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022182 Example :
22183 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22184 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22185 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022187path : string
22188 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22189 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22190 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22191 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22192 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022193 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022194 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22195 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22196 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22197 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22198 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022200 ACL derivatives :
22201 path : exact string match
22202 path_beg : prefix match
22203 path_dir : subdir match
22204 path_dom : domain match
22205 path_end : suffix match
22206 path_len : length match
22207 path_reg : regex match
22208 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022209
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022210pathq : string
22211 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22212 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22213 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22214 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22215 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022216 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22217 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22218 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22219 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22220 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022221
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022222query : string
22223 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22224 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22225 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22226 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022227 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022228 which stops before the question mark.
22229
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022230req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22231 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22232 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22233 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22234 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022236req.ver : string
22237req_ver : string (deprecated)
22238 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022239 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22240 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22241
22242 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22243
22244 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22245 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22246 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022248 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022249 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022250
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022251res.body : binary
22252 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22253 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022254 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22255
22256 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022257
22258res.body_len : integer
22259 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22260 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022261 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22262
22263 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022264
22265res.body_size : integer
22266 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22267 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22268 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22269 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022270 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22271
22272 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022273
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022274res.cache_hit : boolean
22275 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22276 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22277
22278res.cache_name : string
22279 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22280 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22281 empty string.
22282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022283res.comp : boolean
22284 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22285 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22286 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022288res.comp_algo : string
22289 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22290 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22291 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022293res.cook([<name>]) : string
22294scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22295 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22296 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022297 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22298
22299 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022301 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022302 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022304res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22305scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22306 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22307 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022308 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22309
22310 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022312res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22313scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22314 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22315 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022316 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22317
22318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022320res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022321 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22322 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22323
22324 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22325 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22326
22327 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22328
22329 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022331res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022332 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22333 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22334
22335 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22336 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22337
22338 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022340res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22341shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022342 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22343 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22344
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022345 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022346 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22347
22348 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022350 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022351 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22352 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22353 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22354 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22355 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22356 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22357 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22358 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022359
22360res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22361shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022362 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22363 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22364
22365 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022366 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022367
22368 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022370res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22371shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022372 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22373 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22374
22375 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22376
22377 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022378
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022379res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22380 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22381 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22382 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022383 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22384
22385 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022387res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22388shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022389 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22390 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22391
22392 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22393
22394 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022395
22396res.hdrs : string
22397 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22398 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22399 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022400 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22401
22402 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022403
22404res.hdrs_bin : binary
22405 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22406 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22407 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22408 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22409 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22410 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22411 (length of 0 for both).
22412
22413 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22414
22415 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22416 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022418res.ver : string
22419resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22420 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022421 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22422
22423 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022425 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022426 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022428set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22429 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22430 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022431 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022432 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022434 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22435 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022437status : integer
22438 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22439 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022440 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22441
22442 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022443
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022444unique-id : string
22445 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22446 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22447 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22448 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22449 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22450 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022452url : string
22453 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22454 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22455 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22456 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22457 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22458 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022459 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22460 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22461 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22462 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22463 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022465 ACL derivatives :
22466 url : exact string match
22467 url_beg : prefix match
22468 url_dir : subdir match
22469 url_dom : domain match
22470 url_end : suffix match
22471 url_len : length match
22472 url_reg : regex match
22473 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022475url_ip : ip
22476 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22477 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22478 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22479 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022480 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22481 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022483url_port : integer
22484 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022485 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022486
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022487urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22488url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022489 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22490 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022491 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22492 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22493 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22494 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22495 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22496 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22497 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22498 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022500 ACL derivatives :
22501 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22502 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22503 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22504 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22505 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22506 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22507 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22508 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022509
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022511 Example :
22512 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22513 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22514 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22515 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022516
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022517urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022518 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22519 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22520 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022521
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022522url32 : integer
22523 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22524 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22525 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22526 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22527 is an unsigned integer.
22528
22529url32+src : binary
22530 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22531 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22532 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22533
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022534
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200225357.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022536---------------------------------------
22537
22538This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22539used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22540purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22541There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22542or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22543any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22544for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22545
22546internal.htx.data : integer
22547 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22548 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22549
22550internal.htx.free : integer
22551 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22552 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22553
22554internal.htx.free_data : integer
22555 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22556 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22557
22558internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022559 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22560 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22561 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022562
22563internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22564 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22565 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22566
22567internal.htx.size : integer
22568 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22569 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22570
22571internal.htx.used : integer
22572 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22573 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22574 direction.
22575
22576internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22577 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22578 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22579 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22580 of the special value :
22581 * head : The oldest inserted block
22582 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022583 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022584
22585internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22586 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22587 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22588 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22589 integer or one of the special value :
22590 * head : The oldest inserted block
22591 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022592 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022593
22594internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22595 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22596 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22597 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22598 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22599
22600 * head : The oldest inserted block
22601 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022602 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022603
22604internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22605 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22606 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22607 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22608 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22609
22610 * head : The oldest inserted block
22611 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022612 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022613
22614internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22615 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22616 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22617 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22618 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22619
22620 * head : The oldest inserted block
22621 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022622 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022623
22624internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22625 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22626 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22627 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22628 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22629
22630 * head : The oldest inserted block
22631 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022632 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022633
22634internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22635 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22636 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22637 it returns false.
22638
22639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200226407.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022641---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022643Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22644every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022645order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022647ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022648---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22649FALSE always_false never match
22650HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22651HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22652HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022653HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022654HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22655HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22656HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22657HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022658LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022659METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22660METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22661METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22662METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22663METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22664METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22665METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22666METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22667RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22668REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22669TRUE always_true always match
22670WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22671---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022672
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226748. Logging
22675----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022676
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022677One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22678provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22679very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22680provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22681state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022682to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022683headers.
22684
22685In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22686about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22687send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22688
22689 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22690 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22691 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22692 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22693 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022694 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022695 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022696
22697The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22698allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22699as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22700while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22701real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22702delay.
22703
22704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227058.1. Log levels
22706---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022707
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022708TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022709source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022710HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22711in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22712track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22713syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22714about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022715
22716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227178.2. Log formats
22718----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022719
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022720HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022721and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22722slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22723options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022724
22725 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22726 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22727 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22728 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22729 extents.
22730
22731 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22732 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22733 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22734 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22735 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22736
22737 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22738 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22739 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22740 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22741 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22742
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022743 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22744 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22745 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22746 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22747
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022748 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22749
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022750Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22751specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22752field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22753servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22754always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22755identifier.
22756
22757Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22758 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22759 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22760 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22761 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22762
22763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227648.2.1. Default log format
22765-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022766
22767This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22768as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22769format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22770
22771 Example :
22772 listen www
22773 mode http
22774 log global
22775 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22776
22777 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22778 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22779 (www/HTTP)
22780
22781 Field Format Extract from the example above
22782 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22783 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22784 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22785 4 'to' to
22786 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22787 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22788
22789Detailed fields description :
22790 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22791 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22792 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22793 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22794 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22795 and processed the connection.
22796 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22797
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022798In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22799"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22800connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22801
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022802It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22803will eventually disappear.
22804
22805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228068.2.2. TCP log format
22807---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022808
22809The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22810is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22811information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22812counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22813emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22814environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22815the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22816sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022817specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022818not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22819
22820The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22821exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022822if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22823Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022824
22825 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22826 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22827 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022828 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22829 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022830
22831A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22832are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022833
22834 Example :
22835 frontend fnt
22836 mode tcp
22837 option tcplog
22838 log global
22839 default_backend bck
22840
22841 backend bck
22842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22843
22844 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22845 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22846 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22847
22848 Field Format Extract from the example above
22849 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22850 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22851 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22852 4 frontend_name fnt
22853 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22854 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22855 7 bytes_read* 212
22856 8 termination_state --
22857 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22858 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22859
22860Detailed fields description :
22861 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022862 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022863 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22864 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022865 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022866 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022867 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022868
22869 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022870 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22871 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22872 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022873
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022874 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022875 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22876 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022877 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22878 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22879 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22880 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022881
22882 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22883 and processed the connection.
22884
22885 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22886 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22887 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22888 applications.
22889
22890 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22891 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22892 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22893 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22894 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22895
22896 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22897 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22898 See "Timers" below for more details.
22899
22900 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22901 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22902 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22903 "Timers" below for more details.
22904
22905 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022906 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022907 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22908 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22909 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22910 details.
22911
22912 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22913 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22914 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22915 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22916 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22917
22918 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22919 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22920 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22921 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22922 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22923 for more details.
22924
22925 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022926 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022927 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22928 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22929 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022930 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022931
22932 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22933 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22934 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22935 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22936 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22937 caused by a denial of service attack.
22938
22939 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22940 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22941 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22942 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22943 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22944 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22945 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22946 denial of service attack.
22947
22948 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22949 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22950 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22951 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22952 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22953 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22954 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22955 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22956 be processed than on other servers.
22957
22958 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22959 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22960 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22961 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022962 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022963 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22964 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22965 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22966 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22967 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22968 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22969 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22970 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22971
22972 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22973 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22974 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22975 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22976 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22977 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022978 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022979 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22980
22981 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22982 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22983 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22984 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22985 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22986 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022987 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022988 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22989 occurs.
22990
22991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229928.2.3. HTTP log format
22993----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022994
22995The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22996is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22997the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22998are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22999emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
23000generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
23001"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
23002which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023003frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
23004is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023005
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023006The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23007exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023008if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23009instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023010
23011 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
23012 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23013 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
23014
23015And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
23016this exact string:
23017
23018 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
23019 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
23020 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
23021 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023022 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
23023 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023025Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
23026slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
23027with a star ('*') after the field name below.
23028
23029 Example :
23030 frontend http-in
23031 mode http
23032 option httplog
23033 log global
23034 default_backend bck
23035
23036 backend static
23037 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
23038
23039 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23040 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
23041 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023042 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023043
23044 Field Format Extract from the example above
23045 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23046 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023047 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023048 4 frontend_name http-in
23049 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023050 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023051 7 status_code 200
23052 8 bytes_read* 2750
23053 9 captured_request_cookie -
23054 10 captured_response_cookie -
23055 11 termination_state ----
23056 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23057 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23058 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23059 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23060 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023061
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023062Detailed fields description :
23063 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023064 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023065 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
23066 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023067 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023068 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010023069 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023070
23071 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010023072 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
23073 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
23074 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023075
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023076 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023077 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023078
23079 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23080 and processed the connection.
23081
23082 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23083 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23084 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23085
23086 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23087 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23088 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23089 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23090 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23091 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23092
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023093 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23094 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23095 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023096 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023097 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23098 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023099 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023100 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023101
23102 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23103 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023104 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023105
23106 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23107 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023108 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23109 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023110
23111 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23112 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23113 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23114 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23115 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023116 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23117 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023118
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023119 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023120 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23121 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23122 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23123 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23124 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23125 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023126 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023127
23128 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023129 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23130 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023131
23132 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23133 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023134 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023135 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23136 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23137 overflowing.
23138
23139 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23140 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23141 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23142 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23143 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23144 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23145 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23146 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23147
23148 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23149 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23150 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23151 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23152 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23153 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23154 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23155 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23156
23157 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23158 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23159 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23160 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23161 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23162 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23163 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23164
23165 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023166 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023167 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23168 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23169 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023170 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023171 system.
23172
23173 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23174 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23175 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23176 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23177 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23178 caused by a denial of service attack.
23179
23180 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23181 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23182 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23183 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23184 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23185 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23186 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23187 denial of service attack.
23188
23189 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23190 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23191 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23192 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23193 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23194 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23195 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23196 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23197 processed than on other servers.
23198
23199 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23200 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23201 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23202 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023203 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023204 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23205 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23206 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23207 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23208 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23209 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23210 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23211 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23212
23213 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23214 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23215 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23216 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23217 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23218 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023219 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023220 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23221
23222 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23223 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23224 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23225 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23226 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23227 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023228 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023229 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23230 occurs.
23231
23232 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23233 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23234 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23235 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23236 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23237 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23238 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23239 cookies" below for more details.
23240
23241 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23242 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23243 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23244 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23245 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23246 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23247 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23248 and cookies" below for more details.
23249
23250 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23251 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23252 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23253 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23254 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23255 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23256 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23257 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23258
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023259
232608.2.4. HTTPS log format
23261----------------------
23262
23263The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23264extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23265information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23266frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23267end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23268matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23269sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23270dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23271"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23272
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023273The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23274exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023275if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23276instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023277
23278 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23279 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23280 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23281 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023282 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023283 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23284 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023285
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023286This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23287appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23288HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023289
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023290 Example :
23291 frontend https-in
23292 mode http
23293 option httpslog
23294 log global
23295 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23296 default_backend bck
23297
23298 backend static
23299 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23300
23301 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23302 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23303 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023304 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23305 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023306
23307 Field Format Extract from the example above
23308 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23309 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23310 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23311 4 frontend_name https-in
23312 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23313 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23314 7 status_code 200
23315 8 bytes_read* 2750
23316 9 captured_request_cookie -
23317 10 captured_response_cookie -
23318 11 termination_state ----
23319 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23320 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23321 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23322 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23323 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023324 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023325 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023326 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23327 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023328
23329Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023330 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23331 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23332 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023333
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023334 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23335 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23336 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023337 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023338 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023339
23340 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23341 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23342 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23343 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23344
23345 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23346 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23347 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23348 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23349
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023350 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23351 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23352 can be shared by multiple requests.
23353
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023354 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23355 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23356 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23357 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23358 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23359
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023360 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23361
23362 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23363
23364
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100233658.2.5. Error log format
23366-----------------------
23367
23368When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23369protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23370unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23371line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23372"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23373will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23374logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23375
23376The default format looks like this :
23377
23378 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23379 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23380 Connection error during SSL handshake
23381
23382 Field Format Extract from the example above
23383 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23384 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23385 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23386 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23387 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23388
23389These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23390failures.
23391
23392By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23393above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23394defined format.
23395
23396An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23397source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23398number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23399internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23400error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23401the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23402certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23403indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23404indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23405ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23406are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23407would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23408regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23409
23410 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023411 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023412 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23413 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23414
23415
234168.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023417------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023418
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023419When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23420ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23421a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23422formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23423looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23424and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023426HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023427Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23428separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23429prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23430
23431Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23432variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023433("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023434
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023435If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023436as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023437less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23438the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23439
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023440Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23441"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23442delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23443preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023444
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023445Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23446'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23447https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23448such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23449
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023450Flags are :
23451 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023452 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023453 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23454 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023455
23456 Example:
23457
23458 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23459 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23460
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023461 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23462
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023463Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23464
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023465 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023466 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023467 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23468 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23469 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023470 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23471 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23472 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023473 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023474 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023475 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023476 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023477 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023478 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23479 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023480 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023481 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023482 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023483 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023484 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023485 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023486 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023487 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23488 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23489 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23490 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23491 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023492 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023493 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023494 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023495 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023496 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023497 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23498 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023499 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23500 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23501 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023502 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023503 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23504 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023505 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023506 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23507 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23508 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023509 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023510 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023511 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23512 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23513 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23514 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023515 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023516 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023517 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023518 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023519 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023520 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023521 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23522 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23523 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023524 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023525 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23526 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023527 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023528 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23529 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023530 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023531 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023532 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023533 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023534
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023535 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023536
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235388.3. Advanced logging options
23539-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023540
23541Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23542just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23543options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23544for more information about their usage.
23545
23546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235478.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23548------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023549
23550It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023551HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023552commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23553monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23554ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23555
23556 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23557 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23558 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23559 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23560
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023561 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23562 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023563
23564 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23565 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23566 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23567
23568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235698.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23570----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023571
23572The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23573what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23574or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023575"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023576just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23577log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23578after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23579is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23580with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23581with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23582
23583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235848.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23585------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023586
23587Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23588for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23589"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23590retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23591raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23592a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23593file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23594you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23595"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23596
23597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23599--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023600
23601Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23602multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23603them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23604"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23605logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23606error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23607and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23608too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23609useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23610alternative.
23611
23612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236138.4. Timing events
23614------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023615
23616Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23617reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23618the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23619frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023620mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23621addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23622
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023623Timings events in HTTP mode:
23624
23625 first request 2nd request
23626 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23627 t tr t tr ...
23628 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23629 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23630 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23631 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023632 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023633 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23634
23635Timings events in TCP mode:
23636
23637 TCP session
23638 |<----------------->|
23639 t t
23640 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23641 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23642 |<------ Tt ------->|
23643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023644 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023645 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023646 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23647 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23648 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023649 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023650 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23651 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23652 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23653 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023654
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023655 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23656 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23657 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023658 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23659 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23660 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23661 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23662 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23663 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023664
23665 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23666 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23667 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23668 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23669 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23670 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23671 request typed by hand during a test.
23672
23673 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23674 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023675 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023676 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23677 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23678 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23679 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023680
23681 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23682 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23683 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23684 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23685 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23686
23687 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23688 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23689 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23690 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23691 connection never established.
23692
23693 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23694 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23695 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23696 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23697 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23698 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23699 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23700 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23701 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23702 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23703 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23704
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023705 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23706 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23707 (after Tr).
23708
23709 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23710 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023712 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23713 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23714 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23715 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23716 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23717 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23718
23719 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23720
23721 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23722 "Ta" can never be negative.
23723
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023724 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23725 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023726 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23727 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023728 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023730 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023731
23732 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023733 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23734 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023735
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023736 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23737 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23738 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23739 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23740 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23741 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23742 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23743 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023745These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23746protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23747that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023748due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23749"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23750that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023751
23752Most common cases :
23753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023754 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23755 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23756 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23757 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23758 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023759 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023760 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23761 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23762 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23763 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23764 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023765 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023766
23767 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23768 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23769 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23770 of ms on remote networks.
23771
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023772 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23773 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23774 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023775
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023776 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23777 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023778 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023779 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23780 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23781 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23782 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23783 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23784 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023785
23786Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23787
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023788 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023789 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023790 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023792 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023793 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23794 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23795
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023796 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023797 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23798 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23799 flags.
23800
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023801 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23802 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023803 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23804 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23805 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23806 the client connection was maintained open.
23807
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023808 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023809 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023810 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023811 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23812
23813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200238148.5. Session state at disconnection
23815-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023816
23817TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23818"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
238192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23820each of which has a special meaning :
23821
23822 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23823 session to terminate :
23824
23825 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23826
23827 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23828 server explicitly refused it.
23829
23830 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23831 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23832 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23833 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023834 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023835
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023836 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023837
23838 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23839 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23840 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23841 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23842 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23843
23844 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23845 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23846 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23847 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23848 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23849
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023850 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023851 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23852
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023853 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023854 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23855 backup connections when going up.
23856
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023857 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023859 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23860 send or receive data.
23861
23862 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23863 send or receive data.
23864
23865 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23866 with nothing left in the buffers.
23867
23868 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23869
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023870 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023871 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23872
23873 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23874 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23875 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23876 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23877 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23878
23879 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23880 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23881
23882 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23883 server (HTTP only).
23884
23885 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23886
23887 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23888 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23889 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23890
23891 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23892 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23893 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23894
23895 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23896
23897 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23898 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23899
23900 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23901 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23902 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23903
23904 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23905 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023906 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23907 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023908
23909 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23910 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23911 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23912 another server.
23913
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023914 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023915 server.
23916
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023917 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23918 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23919 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23920 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23921
23922 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23923 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23924 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23925 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23926
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023927 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23928 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23929 "use-server" rule).
23930
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023931 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23932
23933 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23934 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23935
23936 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23937
23938 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23939 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23940 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23941
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023942 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23943 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023944 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023945 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23946 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023948 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23949
23950 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23951 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23952
23953 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23954
23955 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23956
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023957The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23958was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023959helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23960starvation, attacks, etc...
23961
23962The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23963alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23964easier finding and understanding.
23965
23966 Flags Reason
23967
23968 -- Normal termination.
23969
23970 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023971 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23972 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023973 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23974
23975 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23976 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023977 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23978 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023979 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23980 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023982 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23983 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023984 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023985
23986 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23987 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23988 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23989
23990 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23991 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23992 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23993 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23994 the server takes too long to respond.
23995
23996 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23997 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23998 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23999 long a time to respond.
24000
24001 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
24002 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
24003 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024004 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024005 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
24006 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024007
24008 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
24009 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
24010 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
24011 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
24012 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020024013 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024014 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
24015 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
24016 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
24017 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
24018 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
24019 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
24020 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
24021 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024022 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020024023 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
24024 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
24025 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024026
24027 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
24028 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020024029 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
24030 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
24031 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
24032 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024033
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010024034 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24035 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
24036 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
24037
24038 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
24039 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
24040 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
24041 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
24042
24043 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
24044 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
24045 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020024046
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024047 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024048 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
24049 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024050 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024051 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
24052 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
24053
24054 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
24055 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
24056 503 or 504 here.
24057
24058 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024059 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024060 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
24061 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
24062 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
24063
24064 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
24065 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024066 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024067 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024068 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024069
24070 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
24071 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
24072 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
24073 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
24074 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
24075 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024076 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024077
24078 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
24079 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
24080 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
24081 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24082 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24083 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24084 solution is to fix the application.
24085
24086 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24087 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24088 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24089 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24090 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24091 external attacks.
24092
24093 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024094 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024095 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024096 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24097 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24098
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024099 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24100 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24101 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024102 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024103 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024104
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024105 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24106 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24107 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24108 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024109 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24110 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24111 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24112 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024113 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24114 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24115 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24116 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024117
24118 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24119 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24120 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024121 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24122 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24123 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24124 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024125
24126 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24127 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24128 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24129 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24130
24131 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24132 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24133 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24134 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024136The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024137persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024138important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24139re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24140
24141 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24142
24143 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24144 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24145 set on a GET request.
24146
24147 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24148 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024149 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024150 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24151
24152 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24153 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24154 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24155
24156 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24157 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24158 already got a cookie.
24159
24160 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24161 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24162 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24163 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24164 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24165
24166 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24167 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24168 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24169
24170 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24171 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24172 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24173
24174 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24175 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24176
24177 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24178 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24179 then advertised in the response.
24180
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241828.6. Non-printable characters
24183-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024184
24185In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24186consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24187converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24188prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24189being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24190escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24191is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24192'}' when logging headers.
24193
24194Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24195issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24196containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24197
24198Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24199the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24200performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24201
24202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24204---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024205
24206Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24207achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024208section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024209cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24210the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24211the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024212locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024213not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24214user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24215a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24216wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24217
24218 Examples :
24219 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24220 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24221
24222 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24223 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24224
24225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242268.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24227---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024228
24229Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24230proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24231the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24232server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24233
24234Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24235response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024236section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024237
24238It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024239time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24240appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024241are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24242and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24243follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24244request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24245in the logs.
24246
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024247As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24248frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24249an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24250
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024251 Example :
24252 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24253 listen proxy-out
24254 mode http
24255 option httplog
24256 option logasap
24257 log global
24258 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24259
24260 # log the name of the virtual server
24261 capture request header Host len 20
24262
24263 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24264 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24265
24266 # log the beginning of the referrer
24267 capture request header Referer len 20
24268
24269 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24270 capture response header Server len 20
24271
24272 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24273 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024275 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024276 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24277
24278 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24279 capture response header Via len 20
24280
24281 # log the URL location during a redirection
24282 capture response header Location len 20
24283
24284 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24285 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24286 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24287 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24288 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24289
24290 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24291 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24292 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24293 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024294 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024295
24296 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24297 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24298 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24299 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24300 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024301 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024302
24303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200243048.9. Examples of logs
24305---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024306
24307These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24308them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24309reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24310
24311 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24312 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24313 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24314
24315 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24316 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24317
24318 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24319 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24320 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24321
24322 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24323 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24324
24325 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24326 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24327 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24328
24329 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024330 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024331 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24332 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24333
24334 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24335 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24336 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24337
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024338 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24339 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24340 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24341 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024342 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024343 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024344
24345 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024346 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024347
24348 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24349 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24350 Nothing was sent to any server.
24351
24352 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24353 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24354
24355 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24356 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024357 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024358 send a 408 return code to the client.
24359
24360 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24361 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24362
24363 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24364 5 seconds ("c----").
24365
24366 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24367 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024368 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024369
24370 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024371 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024372 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24373 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24374 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24375 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24376 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024377
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024378
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200243799. Supported filters
24380--------------------
24381
24382Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24383accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24384unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24385
24386See also : "filter"
24387
243889.1. Trace
24389----------
24390
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024391filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024392
24393 Arguments:
24394 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24395 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24396
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024397 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024398
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024399 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024400 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24401 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24402 amount of the parsed data.
24403
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024404 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024405
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024406This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24407callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24408information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24409filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24410
24411Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24412tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24413a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24414
24415
244169.2. HTTP compression
24417---------------------
24418
24419filter compression
24420
24421The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24422keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024423when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24424fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24425done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24426explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24427filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24428listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24429order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024430
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024431See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24432 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024433
24434
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200244359.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24436--------------------------------------------
24437
24438filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24439
24440 Arguments :
24441
24442 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24443 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24444 parsed.
24445
24446 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24447 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24448 part must be placed in its own scope.
24449
24450The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24451external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024452streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024453exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24454also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24455
24456SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24457the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24458
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024459For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024460"doc/SPOE.txt".
24461
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100244629.4. Cache
24463----------
24464
24465filter cache <name>
24466
24467 Arguments :
24468
24469 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24470
24471The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24472"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024473cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024474other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24475case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24476is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24477filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024478listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24479order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024480
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024481See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24482 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24483
24484
244859.5. Fcgi-app
24486-------------
24487
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024488filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024489
24490 Arguments :
24491
24492 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24493
24494The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24495request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24496reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24497used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24498implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24499used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24500fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24501used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24502order.
24503
24504See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24505 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24506
24507
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100245089.6. OpenTracing
24509----------------
24510
24511The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24512HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24513of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24514Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24515
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024516This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024517
24518The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24519HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24520participates in the work of HAProxy.
24521
24522filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24523
24524 Arguments :
24525
24526 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24527 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24528 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24529 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24530 OpenTracing filters.
24531
24532 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24533 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24534 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24535 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24536 filter must have its own scope defined.
24537
24538More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024539of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024540
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200245419.7. Bandwidth limitation
24542--------------------------
24543
24544filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24545filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24546filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24547filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24548
24549 Arguments :
24550
24551 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24552 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24553
24554 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24555 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24556 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24557 expressed in bytes.
24558
24559 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24560 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24561 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24562 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24563
24564 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24565 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24566 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24567
24568 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024569 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024570 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24571 is expressed in milliseconds.
24572
24573 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24574 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24575 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24576 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24577 expressed in bytes.
24578
24579Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24580speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24581bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24582used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24583sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24584other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24585connections for a given client.
24586
24587The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24588filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24589definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24590the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24591compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24592the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24593for the cache filter.
24594
24595There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24596default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024597to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024598the table.
24599
24600In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24601limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24602forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24603the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24604used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24605cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24606level.
24607
24608The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24609connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24610of the same connection may have different limits.
24611
24612For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24613defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24614bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24615only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24616when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24617
24618For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24619incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24620corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24621stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24622used to limit outgoing data.
24623
24624Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24625limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24626to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24627carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24628it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24629limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24630experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24631a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24632start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24633some experimentations.
24634
24635 Example:
24636 frontend http
24637 bind *:80
24638 mode http
24639
24640 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24641 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24642 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24643
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024644 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024645 # independently of all other streams.
24646 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24647
24648 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24649 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24650 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24651 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24652 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24653 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24654 ...
24655
24656 backend limit-by-src
24657 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24658 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24659
24660See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24661 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24662 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24663 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024664
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002466510. FastCGI applications
24666-------------------------
24667
24668HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24669feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24670the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24671FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24672servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24673FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24674backend.
24675
24676HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24677application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24678connection.
24679
2468010.1. Setup
24681-----------
24682
2468310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24684--------------------------
24685
24686fcgi-app <name>
24687 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24688 document root must be defined.
24689
24690acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24691 Declare or complete an access list.
24692
24693 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24694 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24695 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24696 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24697 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24698
24699docroot <path>
24700 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24701 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24702 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24703
24704index <script-name>
24705 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24706 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24707 is an optional setting.
24708
24709 Example :
24710 index index.php
24711
24712log-stderr global
24713log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024714 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024715 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24716
24717 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24718 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24719
24720pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24721 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24722 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24723 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24724
24725 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24726 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24727 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24728 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24729
24730 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24731 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24732
24733path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024734 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024735 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24736 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24737 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24738 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24739 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24740 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24741 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024742
24743 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024744 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024745 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24746 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24747 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24748 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024749
24750 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024751 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24752 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024753
24754option get-values
24755no option get-values
24756 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24757
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024758 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024759 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24760
24761 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24762 application will accept.
24763
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024764 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24765 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024766
24767 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024768 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024769 option is disabled.
24770
24771 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24772 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24773 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24774 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24775 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24776 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24777
24778option keep-conn
24779no option keep-conn
24780 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24781 sending a response.
24782
24783 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24784 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24785
24786option max-reqs <reqs>
24787 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24788 accept.
24789
24790 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24791 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24792 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24793 to 1.
24794
24795option mpxs-conns
24796no option mpxs-conns
24797 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24798
24799 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24800 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24801
24802set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24803 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24804 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24805 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24806 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24807
24808 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24809 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24810 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24811
24812 Example :
24813 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24814 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24815
24816 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24817
24818
2481910.1.2. Proxy section
24820---------------------
24821
24822use-fcgi-app <name>
24823 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24824
24825 Arguments :
24826 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24827
24828 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24829 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24830 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24831 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24832 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24833
24834 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24835 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24836 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24837 application are evaluated.
24838
24839
2484010.1.3. Example
24841---------------
24842
24843 frontend front-http
24844 mode http
24845 bind *:80
24846 bind *:
24847
24848 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24849 default_backend back-static
24850
24851 backend back-static
24852 mode http
24853 server www A.B.C.D:80
24854
24855 backend back-dynamic
24856 mode http
24857 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24858 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24859
24860 fcgi-app php-fpm
24861 log-stderr global
24862 option keep-conn
24863
24864 docroot /var/www/my-app
24865 index index.php
24866 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24867
24868
2486910.2. Default parameters
24870------------------------
24871
24872A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24873the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024874script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024875applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24876
24877 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24878 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24879 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24880 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24881 | | |
24882 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24883 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24884 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24885 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24886 | | application. |
24887 | | |
24888 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24889 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24890 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24891 | | |
24892 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24893 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24894 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24895 | | the application's configuration. |
24896 | | |
24897 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24898 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24899 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24900 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24901 | | |
24902 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24903 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24904 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24905 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24906 | | be defined. |
24907 | | |
24908 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24909 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24910 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24911 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24912 | | is not set too. |
24913 | | |
24914 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24915 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24916 | | set. |
24917 | | |
24918 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24919 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24920 | | the request. |
24921 | | |
24922 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24923 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24924 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24925 | | |
24926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24927 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24928 | | script to process the request. |
24929 | | |
24930 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24931 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24932 | | |
24933 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24934 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24935 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24936 | | |
24937 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24938 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24939 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24940 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24941 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24942 | | |
24943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24944 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24945 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24946 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24947 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24948 | | side. |
24949 | | |
24950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24951 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24952 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24953 | | connected to. |
24954 | | |
24955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24956 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24957 | | |
24958 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024959 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24960 | | current HAProxy version. |
24961 | | |
24962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024963 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24964 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24965 | | |
24966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24967
24968
2496910.3. Limitations
24970------------------
24971
24972The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24973way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24974during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24975establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24976application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24977or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24978message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24979these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24980and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24981
24982Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24983request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24984requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24985
24986About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24987into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24988fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24989"http-request" ones.
24990
24991Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24992FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24993processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24994must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24995here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024996
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024997
2499811. Address formats
24999-------------------
25000
25001Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
25002address.
25003
25004This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
25005The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
25006of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
25007equivalent is '::'.
25008
25009Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
25010is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
25011
25012This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
25013family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
25014
25015Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
25016configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
25017use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
25018'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
25019
25020Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
25021socket type and the transport method.
25022
25023
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002502411.1. Address family prefixes
25025-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025026
25027'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
25028
25029'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
25030 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
25031 listening.
25032
25033'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
25034 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
25035 on the statement using this address, a port or
25036 a port range may or must be specified.
25037
25038'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25039 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
25040 using this address, a port or a port range
25041 may or must be specified.
25042
25043'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25044 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
25045 using this address, a port or a port range
25046 may or must be specified.
25047
25048'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
25049 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
25050 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
25051 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
25052 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
25053 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
25054
25055'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
25056 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
25057 start by slash '/'.
25058
25059
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002506011.2. Socket type prefixes
25061--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025062
25063Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
25064type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
25065this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
25066This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
25067but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
25068
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025069Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
25070use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
25071sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
25072known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
25073and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025074
25075If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
25076they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
25077report this to the maintainers.
25078
25079'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25080 to "stream"
25081
25082'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25083 to "datagram".
25084
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025085'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25086 method to "stream".
25087
25088
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025089
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002509011.3. Protocol prefixes
25091-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025092
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025093'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25094 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25095 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25096 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25097 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025098 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25099 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025100
25101'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25102 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25103 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25104 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25105 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025106 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25107 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025108
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025109'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25110 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25111 socket type and transport method is forced to
25112 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25113 this address, a port or a port range can or
25114 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25115 of 'stream+ip@'.
25116
25117'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25118 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25119 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25120 statement using this address, a port or port
25121 range can or must be specified.
25122 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25123
25124'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25125 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25126 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25127 statement using this address, a port or port
25128 range can or must be specified.
25129 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25130
25131'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25132 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25133 socket type and transport method is forced to
25134 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25135 this address, a port or a port range can or
25136 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25137 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25138
25139'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25140 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25141 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25142 the statement using this address, a port or
25143 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025144 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025145
25146'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25147 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25148 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25149 the statement using this address, a port or
25150 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025151 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025152
25153'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25154 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25155 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25156
25157'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25158 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25159 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25160
25161In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25162QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025164/*
25165 * Local variables:
25166 * fill-column: 79
25167 * End:
25168 */